237 15 5MB
English Pages [132] Year 1989
The Road to Madiun: The Indonesian Communist Uprising of 1948 Ann Swift
Cornell Modern Indonesia Project Monograph Series
The Road to Madiun: The Indonesian Communist Uprising of 1948 Ann Swift
Monograph Series (Publication no. 69)
Cornell Modern Indonesia Project Southeast Asia Program Cornell University Ithaca, New York 1989
1989 Cornell Modem Indonesia Project ISBN 0-87763-035-6
PRICE: $9.00
Typeset by Coraleen L. Rooney
T able of C ontents
Preface
.......................................................................................................................... vii
A bbreviations........................................................................................................................ix INTRODUCTION ............................................................................................................. 1 I.
SETTING THE STAGE: POLITICAL FORCES IN JAVA IN JANUARY 1948 ................................................................................................. 5 Political Parties in February.............................................................................. 6 The Politicized M ilitary.................................................................................. 12 Above the Parties: The President and Vice President ................................ 14 A Setting for Conflict..;................................................................................... 15 Indonesia and the W orld................................................................................ 16
IL
INTO OPPOSITION-THE BEGINNING.................................................... 17 The Fall of the Sayap K iri.............................................................................. 17 Formation of the Loyal Opposition.................................................................22 The Socialist Camp S plits................................................................................ 24 The Calcutta Conference, Nationalism, and the Cold W a r.......................... 26 H atta—The Consolidation of Political Control ............................................. 30
IIL
THE OPPOSITION M OUNTS....................................................................... 33 Russia Comes to Indonesia: The Suripno A ffair............................................33 The Dutch Threat: Backdrop to the Political S cene......................................39 The Changing Tactics of the F D R ...................................................................40 1. Labor: The Delanggu Strikes .................................................................41 2. The Farmers ............................................................................................43 3. The FDR and the A rm y.......................................................................... 44 The Coalition Government~A Fading Dream ............................................. 48 The Birth of the “International Communist Plot” ........................................50
IV.
INTO REBELLION......................................................................................... 51 Musso................................................................................................................ 51 ‘T h e New Road for the Indonesian Republic” ............................................. 53 The Implementation of the Musso P la n .........................................................56 PKI Into A ctio n ...............................................................................................60 The Specter of the “Moscow Plot” ................................................................ 63 Peristiwa Solo (The Solo A ffair).................................................................... 67 Madiun ............................................................................................................ 73 The F a ll............................................................................................................ 77
V.
EPILOGUE AND CONCLUSION................................................................ 81 American Provocation..................................................................................... 81 The Moscow P lo t............................................................................................. 87 The Misfire T heory......................................................................................... 88 An Open Ending ............................................................................................. 90
APPENDIX A:
Murba Document: People’s Democratic F ront..................................93
APPENDIX B:
Radio Speech by President Sukarno on the Madiun Coup (September 19,1948) ........................................................................ 97
APPENDIX C:
Musso Radio Broadcoast (September 19,1948)............................. 101
SELECTED BIBLIOGRAPHY.................................................................................... 103 ANNOTATED BIBLIOGRAPHY OF THE CONTEMPORARY INDONESIAN PRESS.................................................................................................... 109 NAME IN D E X ............................................................................................................... I l l
I llustrations
Plates
1: 2: 3: 4:
President Sukarno ......................................................................................................xi Vice President H atta General Sudirman Musso
5: 6: 7: 8:
Amir Sjarifuddin............................................................................................................ 4 Sutan Sjahrir Alimin Tan Malaka
9: Haji Agus S alim ...........................................................................................................32 10: Suripno 11: Amir Sjarifuddin 12: S etiadjit................................................................................................. Facing page 50 13: Wikana 14: Abdulmadjid 15: M usso..................................................................................................... Facing page 51 16: Maj. Gen. Djokosujono 17: Harjono 18: Detachment of Communist Troops in Madiun
M ap
Division of Java under the Renville Agreement ...............................................................xii
P reface
My thesis on Madiun was written during a year spent at Cornell studying Southeast Asia on a State Department training program. I had just come from a three-year assign ment in Indonesia (1968-1971) and was being trained for more service in the area. Search ing for a thesis topic, I was drawn to the Madiun period: it was one of the most turbulent periods of the Indonesian revolution and one which had stirred a reasonable amount of controversy. I decided to take an in-depth look at the period, trying to come at it from an Indonesian perspective while keeping an eye cocked to world events. My methodology was simple: I read everything I could find on the subject and talked to as many people as possible. The further I got into my research, the more I realized that the key to understanding what had actually happened in 1948 was the newspapers of the period. These happily were available in abundance in Cornells outstanding library and gave me not only an accurate chronology of events but a first-hand look at how people of the period viewed those events at the time-without the disadvantage of hindsight. I made what were to me some fascinating discoveries (historians’ views of “fascinating” can be a bit obscure) and produced a thesis which is probably a bit more than most people would really like to know about the period. Hating to leave out anything, I added foot notes almost as long as the thesis itself. I had no preconceived notions when I started the thesis and tried to maintain my objec tivity throughout. I was not looking for a particular solution to “what happened” and per haps because of this, the thesis lacks a resounding conclusion. I hope, however, it will add a bit to the knowledge of the period.
Ann Swift American Embassy Kingston, Jamaica June 1988
A bbreviations %
Akoma
Angkatan Komunis Muda
Young Communist Forces
ALRI
Angkatan Laut Republik Indonesia
Republic of Indonesia Navy
BPRI
Barisan Pemberontakan Republik Indonesia
Insurgent Corps of the Republic of Indonesia
BTI
Barisan Tani Indonesia
Indonesian Peasants’ League
BTN
Badan Textil Negara
State Textile Board
CPM
Corps Polisi Militer
Military Police Corps
FDR
Front Demokrasi Rakyat
People’s Democratic Front UN Good Offices Committee
GOC GRR
Gerakan Revolusi Rakyat
People’s Revolutionary Movement
KNIL
Koninklijk Nederlands Indisch Leger
Royal Netherlands Indies Army
KNIP
Komite Nasional Indonesia Pusat
Central Indonesian National Committee
lasykar Masyumi
irregular armed groups (militia) Consultative Council of Indonesian Moslems
Majelis Syuro Muslimin Indonesia
Mobrig
Mobile Brigade
PGRI
Persatuan Guru Republik Indonesia
Republic of Indonesia’s Teacher Union
NIS
Negara Indonesia Serikat
United States of Indonesia
Partindo
Partai Indonesia
Indonesian Party
PBI
Partai Buruh Indonesia
Indonesian Labor Party
Pesindo
Pemuda Sosialis Indonesia
Indonesian Socialist Youth
Peta
Pembela Tanah Air
Defenders of the Fatherland
PKI
Partai Komunis Indonesia
Indonesian Communist Party
ix
PNI
Partai Nasional Indonesia
Indonesian Nationalist Party
PS
Partai Sosialis
Socialist Party
PSI
Partai Sosialis Indonesia
Indonesian Socialist Party
psn
Partai Sarekat Islam Indonesia
Indonesian Islamic Union Party
SARBUPRI Sarekut Buruh Perkebunan Republik Indonesia
Plantation Workers* Union of the Republic of Indonesia
Sayap Kiri
left wing formed in September 1946 made up of PS, PBI, Pesindo, and PKI Sarekat Buruh Gula
Sugar Workers* Association
SI
Sarekat Islam
Islam Association-first mass-based nationalist organization
SOBSI
Sentral Organisasi Buruh Seluruh Indonesia
Central Organization of Indonesian Labor Unions
STII
Sarekat Tani Islam
Indonesian Islamic Farmers’ Association
TNI
Tentara Nasional Indonesia
Indonesian National Army
TNI Masyarakat TP, TRIP WFTU
People’s TNI Tentara Pelajar [Republik Indonesia]
Student Army [of the Republic of Indonesia] World Federation of Trade Unions
President Sukarno
Vice President Hatta
General Sudirman
Musso
xi
White (unshaded) areas remained under Republican control. Shaded areas were to be under Netherlands occupation. Heavy dotted lines show the Renville truce line.
Division o f Java under the Renville Agreement (January 19, 1948)
I ntroduction
The year 1948 was the darkest of the Indonesian revolution. It was a year of negotiated retreat when Indonesian guerrilla units were withdrawn from behind Dutch lines, and a year of uneasy truce as Republican leaders haggled with the Dutch at the conference table and watched with frustration and growing anger the reinstitution of Dutch rule in the greater part of the Indonesian Archipelago. During the year all the tensions of the new Indonesian Republic, deprived of the unifying release of battle against a common enemy, turned inward to boil within the narrow confines of that part of Central and East Java still in Republican hands. Left alone these tensions might not have exploded, but 1948 was also the year Indonesia became inescapably entangled in the Cold War. By September the pressures had become too great, and left and right forces of the Indonesian national revo lution found themselves pitted one against the other in conflict at Madiun. The Madiun revolt has been pictured in many ways. At one extreme is the Communist explanation that Madiun was a US-inspired “provocation,” aimed at forcing the Indone sian Communist Party (PKI) into revolt so it could then be destroyed with impunity by the “right-wing reactionaries” in control of the Republican government.1 At the other ex treme is the right wing’s counter-explanation that the Madiun Affair was part of a closely coordinated Soviet plot for Communist seizure of nationalist governments throughout Southeast Asia.2 Neither of these provides a satisfactory explanation of the deeply com plex forces, both foreign and domestic, at work within Indonesian society which led during the first half of 1948 to an ever-widening rift in the complex pattern of the Indonesian revolutionary forces, a rift which by September 1948 had become irreparable. By the beginning of 1948, the Indonesian Republic for two and a half years had been fighting a steadily losing battle against the reinstitution of Dutch colonial rule in the Neth erlands East Indies. This battle was fought more at the conference table than in the field, as Indonesia’s leaders chose to follow the path of negotiated settlement rather than that of protracted guerrilla warfare.3 The Dutch, on the other hand, showed little desire to come to terms with a group of rebels whom they considered incapable of enforcing a rule of law in Indonesia.4*Up to July of 1947, the Dutch strategy was to talk with the Republican gov-
1 See Miràjadi, “Tiga Tahun Provokasi Madiun,” Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1951. 2 See the Masyumi-run newspaper A badi, September 4,1953. 3 The conflict between the exponents of “diplomasi” and the guerrilla warfare of “revolusi” is best portrayed in Benedict R.O’G. Anderson, Java in a Time o f Revolution (Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1972). 4 The US Department of State, Foreign Relations o f the United States 1947 (hereafter F R U S1947), vol. 6, The Far East (Washington: US Government Printing Office, 1972), p. 981, gives an example of this Dutch attitude.
1
2 ernment while slowly building its forces for an armed takeover of the Republican-held areas of Java and Sumatra. On July 20,1947, the Dutch sent their forces into Republicanheld territory, stopping only after they had taken over the most productive areas of the Re public.5 While the Dutch frontal attack ceased on August 3, scattered fighting continued until the end of the year, especially in West Java, as Republican forces, cut off from their Yogyakarta capital by Dutch columns, fought back in savage guerrilla warfare. By early January 1948, United Nations pressure had again forced the Republicans and the Dutch into new agreements. These “Renville Agreements,” as they were called, had four major points: they called for a full cease-fire in all parts of Indonesia and for the withdrawal of Republican troops from Dutch-held territory. This was to be counterbalanced by a Dutch agreement to hold plebiscites in the former Republican areas it now occupied to determine if they wished to return to the Republic or to become separate states in the “United States of Indonesia” (NIS). As previously agreed in the Linggajati Agreements, this “United States of Indone sia” was then to become an independent self-governing member of the Kingdom of the Netherlands.6 The Republic agreed to these conditions with the knowledge that, if they did not, the Dutch would probably launch another frontal attack to take those areas of Java and Sumatra (Bukittinggi, Lampung, Aceh, Yogyakarta, and Banten) still under Republican control. The Republicans were also fairly confident that, if free elections were held in Dutch areas, sentiment was such that the Republic would regain by the ballot what it had lost to the Dutch armies.7 Acceptance of the Renville Agreements caused an immediate parliamentary crisis in the Republic, and the agreements were to become a major source of contention in the months that followed. As the Dutch broke one after another of the Renville principles, refused to hold plebiscites, and plainly stalled for time in political discussions over the fusion of the Republic with the NIS, pressure grew steadily stronger within the Republic to take a firmer stand against the Dutch. Acceptance of the Renville Agreements was to have two far-reaching consequences for the Republic, consequences which were to lead directly to Madiun. First, by accepting the cease-fire and withdrawal of troops, the Republic was accepting a state of uneasy peace where it would have time to concentrate on its own internal problems. These problems were intensified by the tight Dutch blockade aimed (in contravention of Renville) at bring ing the Republic to its knees economically. In addition, the people and politics of Repub lican Indonesia were now concentrated within an area on Java less than a third of its for mer size. The influx of troops and refugees into Republican-held territory tripled the
Dutch propaganda organs also continually castigated the Indonesians either as pro-Japanese collaborators (Sukarno, Hatta) or as Communist influenced. One good example of the latter was given by Dutch right-wing leader D. V. Stikker who, in a speech on June 26,1948, said that the government behind Sukarno was very left wing and even Hatta, the Masyumi, and the Catholic Party were PKI-influenced (Merdeka, June 28, 1948). M erdeka, July 1,1948, p. 1, also discusses this Dutch anti-Communist attitude. 5 George McT. Kahin, N ationalism and Revolution in Indonesia (Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1952), pp. 215-16. The Dutch quite probably had no intention of taking over all the territory of the Republic at this time, see F R U S1947, vol. 6, pp. 942-45 and 989-90. 6 Alastair M. Taylor, Indonesian Independence an d the Untied N ations (Ithaca: Cornell University Press, 1960), pp. 468-70. 7 Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 228-29.
3 population of the capital city of Yogyakarta (from 300,000 to 900,000)8 and brought with it the problems of both feeding and employing the refugees. As troops from the more Mos lem, Sundanese-speaking areas of West Java were quartered amongst their Javanese neighbors, clashes occurred over housing, food, and arms, and these were then exacer bated by linguistic, religious, and cultural differences. With 35,000 troops evacuated from “pockets” in Dutch territory, and a surplus of squabbling military commanders and politi cally oriented armed youth groups, the Republic could no longer avoid taking the danger ous political decisions necessary to bring its fighting forces under centralized control. The Renville Agreements also gave the Republic’s right and centrist groups (the Masyumi and PNI) the opportunity to oust the left-wing coalition (the Sayap Kiri) which had governed Indonesia since 1946. Republican Vice President H atta’s inability to get left-wing participation in the new government, formed on January 29,1948, was to prove disastrous. At first, the left wing promised to form a loyal opposition to give constructive criticism. However, as the other groups gradually consolidated their power in the govern ment, the Sayap Kiri became increasingly isolated and its opposition increasingly radical. The confrontation between left and right was to continue to grow over the months that followed the signing of the Renville Agreements, ending at last in armed conflict at Madiun. 8 Andrew Roth, “Jokja Journal,” The N ation, June 26,1948. Roth was a member o f the Institute o f Pacific Relations and a reporter for The N ation. D espite his strong sympathy for the Republic, his writing seem s gen erally quite balanced.
4
Alim in
Tan Malaka
S etting
C hapter i T he S tage: P olitical F orces I n J ava I n J anuary 1948
Since November 1945, the Indonesian Republic had been led by a coalition of Socialist groups called appropriately the “Sayap Kiri” or “left wing.” Most of these “left-wing” cabinets, however, first under Sjahrir and then under Amir Sjarifuddin, included represen tatives from the Republic’s other important political groupings, the Indonesian Nationalist Party (Partai Nasional Indonesia, PNI) and the coalition of Moslem organizations known as the Masyumi. However, in the early revolution attempts to classify organizations as “right” or “left” were misleading. As Sutan Sjahrir later pointed out, most Indonesian nationalists on all sides of the political spectrum were influenced by the ideas of socialism, and the question was never one of pro- or anti-socialism.1 This “socialism,” however, was defined in many ways, from the “pure” Communist variety, through Sukarno’s hazy popu list “Marhaenism,” to the “religious” socialism of the Moslems which was hardly socialism at all. While political ideology was to play an increasingly important role in 1948, more meaningful divisions within Indonesia’s ruling elite, as Ruth McVey points out, were based on “collaboration versus non-collaboration with the colonial regime, on orientation to wards traditional cultural and religious values or towards secular nationalism.”2 Personal relationships, the leader (bapak) to his followers (atiak buah), friendships, and “old boy” networks (among Sjahrir socialists or among military officers who had served in the Japa nese-sponsored Peta [Pembela Tanah Air, Defenders of the Fatherland]), often overrode ideological leanings. It was not unusual, for instance, for a hot-headed radical to remain within a more conservative grouping (or vice versa) putting aside his ideological leanings for the sake of personal friendships or relations. In 1948, politics in Indonesia were played mostly in Java, especially in those parts of East and Central Java still held by the Republic. Traditional sociological differences go deeper within these two areas than in almost any other part of Indonesia and all the poli tics of 1948 were acted against the background of latent and, as yet not fully developed, communal tensions. Two main cultural streams exist in Java, santri (or Moslem) and abangan (word used to designate those nominal Moslems to whom traditional HinduBuddhist and animist beliefs are more meaningful than Islam). When Islam came to Indo nesia in the thirteenth to fifteenth centuries, it penetrated deeply into Sumatra and West Java and along the coastal trading regions in Central and East Java, but the Central Java nese heartland was only partially affected. The development of Islam in Java has a com-
1 Sutan Sjahrir, Indonesian Socialism (Rangoon: Asian Socialist Publishing House, 1956), pp. 30-31. 2 Ruth T. McVey, “The Southeast Asian Insurrectionary Movements” in Communism and Revolution, The Stratege Uses o f P olitical Violence, ed. Cyril E. Black (Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press, 1964), p. 149.
5
6 plex history, but by 1948 a pattern had developed where the Indonesian trading communi ties, many medium-sized landowners, and some of the peasantry were strongly Islamic (santri), while the civil service (drawn by the Dutch from aristocratic Javanese families) and a large segment of the peasant population were abangan. The pattern of santri and abangan communities in Java followed little rhyme or reason. Large parts of West Java were heavily santri, Central Java was heavily abangan with santri communities sprinkled throughout-and East Java a bewildering mix. Differences between santri and abangan have influenced the composition of political movements in Indonesia throughout the twentieth century. This split was plainly apparent in 1948 when a current of communalism underlay much of the political scene. The left wing or Sayap Kiri and the Nationalist Party, the PNI, were secular parties appealing to abangan and, in the case of the Sjahrir socialists, also to a few highly educated liberal Moslems in the trading community. The Masyumi, on the other hand, was a religious party. Openly Islamic in its appeal, it drew to its banner urban-oriented, modernist Mos lems as well as followers of traditional Islam whose beliefs were deeply rooted in Javanese villages.3 While little of this communalist undercurrent will be apparent in the story that follows, it must be kept in mind at all times for it is to reappear with a vengeance at the story’s climax. P olitical Parties in February
The ruling Sayap Kiri socialist coalition was formed in September 1946, from four or ganizations: the Socialist Party (PS) claiming about 30,000 members; the Indonesian La bor Party (Partai Buruh Indonesia, PBI), a small organization of about 1,000 members; the large, armed paramilitary Indonesian Socialist Youth organization (Pemuda Sosialis Indonesia, Pesindo), with approximately 100,000 members; and the small Indonesian Communist Party (Partai Komunis Indonesia, PKI), with about 3,000 members.4 The Sayap Kiri also exercised control over two other organizations: the Central Organization of Indonesian Labor Unions (Sentral Organisasi Buruh Seluruh Indonesia, SOBSI), which claimed a membership before the first Dutch “police action” of over one million mem bers, and the smaller Indonesian Peasants League (Barisan Tani Indonesia, BTI).5 The Socialist Party which led the Sayap Kiri was itself a coalition of two groups: the Sjahrir socialists, a small compact group of moderate socialist intellectuals whose influ ence was greatest amongst the Jakarta elite and in West Sumatra;6*and a more radical grouping centered around Amir Sjarifuddin, a popular and dynamic leader whose main
3 Clifford Geertz, The Religion o f Java (New York, NY: The Free Press, 1960), pp. 121-224. 4 For estimated strength of the Sayap Kiri see Roth, “Jokja Journal,” p. 176; also see Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri dari Sebuah Djalan” (M A . thesis, University of Indonesia, 1969), p. 83. Figures on PKI strength in early 1948 range from 2,000-3,000. PKI Chairman Alimin claimed 2,000 in an interview with a newsman in June 1948 (see Berita Indonesia, June 8,1948, p. 2). PKI leader Suripno, however, in early September gave George Kahin a figure of 2,500 for Java and 500 for Sumatra (see Kahin, N ationalism , p. 257). 5 Ibid., p. 261. 6 M erdeka, March 3,1948, p. 2. According to M erdeka, when Sjahrir broke with Amir in February 1948, he car ried with him Partai Sosialis branches in West Java, Sumatra, and some parts o f East Java.
7 source of support was among the youths of the East Java-based Pesindo.7 The AmirSjahrir combination evidently worked well during the first Sjahrir cabinets. Sjahrir, with his well-known disdain for organizational work, supplied the calm, dispassionate leader ship and diplomatic skills necessary to build the image of the Indonesian Republic at the international negotiating table. Amir, on the other hand, as an orator second only to Sukarno and a skilled organizer, provided the party with the dynamic appeal among the masses which, for all his admitted brilliance, Sjahrir was unable to match. The SjahrirAmir partnership, however, broke down in July 1947, when Amir withdrew his support in protest over Sjahrir’s concessions to the Dutch, and caused the fall of the third Sjahrir cabinet. Although Amir almost immediately reversed himself, Sjahrir, obviously angered and perhaps realizing the hopelessness of staving off a Dutch attack, refused to re-form his government.8 Amir was then given the task of leading the next Sayap Kiri cabinet, and Sjahrir almost immediately went abroad to become the spokesman of the Republic’s cause in Europe and at the United Nations. Although relations between Amir and Sjahrir were obviously strained on Sjahrir’s departure, Sjahrir’s followers remained within the Partai Sosialis, probably hoping to exercise some moderating influence over the party which, af ter Sjahrir’s departure, came increasingly under the control of Amir’s followers. The threat of “communism” (especially Stalinist communism) appeared almost negli gible to most Indonesians at the beginning of 1948. The Communist takeover in Czecho slovakia had not yet occurred, the Zhdanov two-camp thesis was not yet being applied in Indonesia, and Moscow had been nothing but a firm ally of the young Indonesian Republic at the United Nations. While Dutch propaganda organs were continuously charging that the Republic was Communist-dominated if not Communist-run,9 Indonesians were well aware that the Indonesian Communist Party (PKI) was small and not particularly power ful or well led. The Indonesian Republic had been under Sayap Kiri leadership almost since its inception, yet there was little sign of it becoming a “People’s Republic.” The PKI at the beginning of 1948 was indeed a small and insignificant party, and an almost totally silent partner in the Sayap Kiri cabinets. In 1946, the PKI Congress had decided not to join Sjahrir’s cabinet for fear of laying the cabinet open to the charge of being Communist influenced10 and even Amir’s cabinet had only one known Communist, Maruto Darusman, as minister of state.11 The PKI’s low posture appears to have been due to two factors: to the PKI’s adherence to the Dimitrov Line which called for cooperation
7 S. P. Derita, L im a Minggu Sebelum M adiun A ffair (Medan: Toko Buku Sarkawi, 1949), p. 7. A lso see Merdekaf March 3,1948, p. 2, which reports that in the split with Sjahrir, Partai Sosialis branches in East and Cen tral Java remained almost entirely loyal to Amir. 8 For accounts o f the fall of Sjahrir’s cabinet, see Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 207-8; Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 94; and Ruth T. McVey, The Soviet View o f the Indonesian Revolution (Ithaca, NY: Cornell M odem Indone sia Project, 1957), the arguments of Setiadjit, PBI leader and secret PKI member until August 1948, who just after Sjahrir’s fall returned to Indonesia from a meeting of the Communist-controlled World Federation of Trade Unions (W FTU). McVey raises the question o f whether or not Setiadjit might have been carrying “orders from Moscow” which caused Amir’s reversal, but concludes “we cannot point to the Sajap Kiri’s rever sal as tangible evidence o f Soviet policy in Indonesia.” McVey, Soviet View, p. 21. 9 See M erdekat July 1, 1948, p. 1, for discussion o f the Dutch attitude. For an example o f this type o f Dutch propaganda, see Dr. William F. de Bruyn, The Rising Soviet Star aver Indonesia (The Hague: “D e Hofstad,” 1947?). 10 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” pp. 84-85. 11 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 211.
8 with the national bourgeoisie in the anti-imperialist struggle12 and to the mediocre quality of the PKI’s leadership. In 1948, the PKI was under the dual leadership of Sardjono and Alimin. Sardjono seems to have been a weak and fairly nondescript leader.13 Alimin, on the other hand, had international Communist credentials: a leader of the PKI’s ill-fated rebellion in 1926-1927, Alimin spent the years from 1927-1940 in the USSR, 1940-1945 in China, and returned to Indonesia in 1946, via Vietnam where he apparently met Ho Chi Minh.14 As later events were to prove, however, Alimin was an Indonesian nationalist first and foremost and quite content to hold the PKI to a supportive role in the Indonesian revolution. Nevertheless, the Communist role in the Indonesian revolution was a deceptive one, for along with the Dimitrov Line of cooperation with the nationalists, went a policy of infiltra tion and control of left-wing organizations by underground PKI members. By early 1948, underground Communist members had control of main leadership positions in all the Sayap Kiri organizations, and exercised great influence in SOBSI. In the Partai Sosialis, two top leaders, Abdulmadjid and Tan Ling Djie, became members of the Dutch Commu nist Party before returning to Indonesia after the war in 1948,15 and Amir Sjarifuddin ap parently considered himself a PKI member.16 Labor Party leader Setiadjit had also been a member of the Dutch Communist Party while in Holland, and the Pesindo was completely under PKI domination with Krissubanu and Wikana in leading positions.17 The PKI had also been successful in taking over the SOBSI leadership, with Harjono as general chair man, Setiadjit vice chairman, and Njono general secretary.18 PKI control, however, did not run deep within some of the unions, and the peasants’ organization, the BTI, remained under the control of the Sjahrir socialists.19*
12 Arnold C. Brackman, Indonesian Communism (New York, NY: Praeger, 1963), pp. 29,53. 13 Ruth T. McVey, The Rise o f Indonesian Communism (Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1965), pp. 272, 484, and Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 6. 14 Alimin Prawirodirdjo, R iw ajat H idup A lim in (Jakarta: Kesedjahteraan N.V., 1954), pp. 29-30. 15 McVey, “Insurrectionary Movements,” p. 165. 16 On August 29, 1948, Amir publicly declared that he had been recruited as a member of the underground PKI by Musso in 1935 (Berita Indonesia, September 1,1948, p. 1). At almost the same time, Amir also de clared himself to be a faithful Christian (see ibid., September 9,1948). This, and Amir’s individualism raised severe doubts in the minds of many as to whether Amir was in fact a Communist. Many simply felt that he feared he was losing his following to Musso, and hoped to join the bandwagon by declaring himself to be a Communist. On the other hand, he was fully accepted into the new PKI Politbureau in a position of influence. There is little question that Amir worked extremely closely with the underground PKI during the war (see Anderson, Java, pp. 205-6), and was very far to the left. Given the loose structure of the PKI during and after the war, it is quite possible for Amir to have considered himself part of the Communist Party without ever having been subject to its discipline. It is very clear, however, from Amir’s speeches that he never became immersed in doctrinaire Communist ideology. For various views on this problem, see Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 272-75; M adjallahM erdeka, September 11,1948, p. 6; PKI History Institute, Forty Years o f the Communist Party o f Indonesia, JPRS Translation (Washington, D.C.: US Joint Public Research Service, 1961), p. 22; John Coast, Recruit to Revolution (London: Christophers, 1952), p. 163; and Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” pp. 36,97. 17 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” pp. 69-71, on Wikana, Krissubanu, and Setiadjit. A lso see Kahin, N ational ism , p. 273. 18 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 68. 19 Ibid., p. 67; Kahin, N ationalism , p. 284. The PKI was not to gain control of the BTI until 1953; see Donald Hindley, The Comm unist Party o f Indonesia 1951-1965 (Berkeley: University of California Press, 1964), p. 160.
9 While secret PKI control of the Sayap Kiri leadership was impressive, it also had its drawbacks which were to be plainly shown in the months to come. With the exception of the PKI group trained in Holland, few of the younger PKI members had any formal Com munist training, and discipline was undoubtedly lax. Thus, while youth leaders like Wikana may have considered themselves Communists, their actual training was minimal.20 In addition, while PKI members might secretly hold positions of control in Sayap Kiri organizations, they were unable actively to recruit new members or to indoctrinate their organizations openly in Communist ideology. A major case in point is Amir himself, who, while he apparently considered himself a Communist, gives little indication of any thor ough knowledge of Communist ideology or terminology.21 Thus, while the secret PKI organization at the beginning of 1948 disposed of consider able influence, it was disorganized, scattered, and untrained. The PKI also gave little indi cation of being a disciplined part of an international Communist movement. This was probably due in part to lack of interest in Southeast Asia by the Soviet Union through 1947 and to the fact that the Dimitrov Line, in simply calling on the PKI to support the national revolution, put no restraints on the party's inherent nationalism. As will be seen later, the Zhdanov “Two Camp Doctrine” of 1947, which demanded absolute adherence to the So viet camp and declared “neutralism” an impossibility, was not forced on the PKI until August of 1948. While the Zhdanov Line, as elaborated by the Soviet East Asian specialist Zhukov in BoVshevik, did point to the unreliability of the bourgeois nationalists in the in dependence struggle, Vietnam and Indonesia until Amir's fall were to be singled out as examples of the correct application of the new line, where proletarian forces were taking the leading role in the revolution.22 Thus, at the beginning of 1948, the PKI, both legal and illegal, were supporting the conservative “diplomasi” line of negotiation with the Dutch initiated by Sjahrir and continued by Amir . This line necessitated such heresy as a friendly posture toward the United States and a willingness to protect the holdings of foreign in vestors (including Dutch) in Republican areas while the negotiations were going on.23 At the opposite end of the political spectrum from the Sayap Kiri was the Masyumi, a conglomeration of Moslem organizations, which with more than 500,000 members24 was the largest political party in the Republic. While basically “conservative” in outlook,
20 The Sayap Kiri did train cadre at their “Marx House” training center in Madiun. Marx House seems to have been run, however, both by Amir and Sjahrir socialists; see Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 70, and Mochtar Lubis in M adjaUah M erdeka, February 14,1948. The need for better-trained cadre was also set out clearly in August 1948, in the PKI’s D jalan Bam untuk Republik Indonesia (republished in Jakarta, 1953), p. 33. Suripno was to deplore the lack of training in the PKI in his writings from jail, published after his capture in late 1948; see Djamal Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun (Jakarta: Merdeka Press, 1966), p. 93. A lso see D . N. Aidit, A Short History o f the Com m unist Party (New Delhi: Peoples Publishing House, 1955), p. 24. 21 Amiris last public radio address, given from Madiun while the city was still in Communist hands in Septem ber 1948, is a classic example o f Amiris notable lack of Communist terminology in his speeches. See Front N asional, September 24,1948. 22 For a full discussion of Soviet attitudes towards Indonesia in 1947, see McVey, Soviet View, pp. 11-37. A lso see A. Zhdanov, Situasi P olitik Intem asional (Yogyakarta: Mingguan Revolusioner, 1948) and Zhukov, “The Aggravations o f the Crisis of the Colonial System,” BoVshevik, December 15, 1947, in H elene Carrere D ’Encausse and Stuart R. Schram, Marxism and A sia (London: Allen Lane, 1969), pp. 261-63. 23 It should be remembered, however, that at this time H o Chi Minh in Vietnam was also following a very mild line, which had the US government convinced that, if H o was indeed a Communist, he was not controlled from Moscow (The Pentagon Papers, Senator Gravel edition [Boston: Beacon Press, 1971], vol. 1, p. 34). 24 Roth, “Jokja Journal,” p. 716.
10 Masyumi’s leadership at the beginning of 1948 was an odd combination of young Moslem “Socialists” like Sjafruddin Prawiranegara and Mohammad Natsir, and traditional reli gious leaders like Wachid Hasjim.25 This group was held together by the skillful, moderate leadership of Dr. Sukiman, who combined an ability to appeal to the Masyumi’s rural Moslem constituency with a reasonably modernist outlook.26 More than anything else, Islam and the idea of creating an Islamic state in Indonesia was the driving force behind the Masyumi party. Even the modernist leaders, who tended to be pragmatic rather than zealous, were often forced to take more conservative stands to maintain the support of their traditionalist followers. This driving concern for Islam led political opponents of the Masyumi to see it as a party with few intellectuals, a party of fanatics who did everything in the name of Allah.27 To some extent this was true. While the upper levels of the Masyumi leadership did contain modernist Moslem intellectuals, the mass base of the party de pended on a largely illiterate but deeply Moslem peasantry.28 The middle-level leadership group of the Masyumi also tended to be primarily composed of village religious leaders, medium-sized land holders, and small traders,29 a factor adding to the party’s religious outlook and conservatism on questions of land holding and private business. Enmity between the Masyumi and the Communists traced back to the early 1920s and the bitter struggle then between Moslem leaders and the Communists in the Sarekat Islam (SI) which resulted in the expulsion of the PKI from the SI in 1921.30 The Masyumi re garded the secularly oriented Sayap Kiri with a distrust born of the split in Javanese soci ety between the santri and abangan and intensified by the Masyumi’s suspicion of the athe ism and radicalism of the Western-oriented (at times Dutch-educated) left-wing leaders. The PKI was particularly disliked for its atheism, which the Masyumi, not the PKI, was increasingly to stress during 1948. While firm in their antipathy toward the Communists,31 the Masyumi also tended to be pro-American, and the close relations between the US diplomats in Jakarta and Masyumi leaders, especially Sukiman, was much noted in the press.32 Like the Sayap Kiri, the Masyumi had its own paramilitary organizations, the Hizbullah and Sabilillah, as well as labor and peasant organizations. All of this made the Masyumi a powerful force and one which had been underrepresented in previous govern ments.
25 George McT. Kahin, “Some Aspects of Indonesian Politics and Nationalism.” Paper for the 11th Confer ence o f the Institute o f Pacific Relations (Lucknow, 1950), pp. 3-6. 26 See Berita Indonesia, March 16,1948, p. 3, for a description of Sukiman’s leadership. “Socialist” is probably a misnomer for these modernist Moslems who saw their socialism in terms of increased government ownership o f communications and utilities, and were often staunch advocates of private property. Sjafruddin, for in stance, was to become one of Indonesia’s foremost businessmen. A lso see Kahin, “Some Aspects,” pp. 3-8, for a discussion of “religious socialism.” 27 Berita Indonesia, March 16,1948, p. 3. 28 Ibid. 29 Roth, “Jokja Journal,” p. 716. 30 McVey, R ise o f Indonesian Communism, pp. 138-46,155. 31 Masyumi distaste for the PKI was plainly evident throughout the revolution, and appears again and again in dispatches from the US Consulate in Batavia to the State Department. See FRU S1947, vol. 6, pp. 898-1101, and the report o f an interview with Abu Hanifah in Siasat, March 15,1947, p. 9. This dislike, however, does not seem to have flared into real enmity with communal undertones until 1948. 32 Manai Sofian, “Surat dari Jokja,” M erdeka, February 14, 1948, p. 4. Manai Sofian was one of the PNI’s younger, more radical members.
11 Second in size to the Masyumi, the PNI (Indonesian Nationalist Party) occupied a swing position between them and the Sayap Kiri. A party whose leadership was drawn from Indonesia’s educated elite of civil servants and teachers, the PNI was fairly conserva tive in outlook but also secular. Its appeal to its mass following of abangan peasants was due more to traditional ties of respect for authority vested in the aristocratic civil service than to ideology or religious appeal. Toward the middle of 1948, the PNI’s younger left wing, dose in outlook to the Sayap Kiri, formed a coalition with the PNI center forces and captured much of the PNI’s leadership, forcing the older, more conservative dvil servantaristocrats to desert the party by the end of 1948.33 At the beginning of 1948, however, the PNI had both conservatives and liberals under a single umbrella. While, during 1948, it was to work in coalition with the Masyumi, the PNI, unlike the Masyumi, never came out in full opposition to the Sayap Kiri. Completely lacking the Masyumi’s religious anti communism, the PNI attempted to act as a buffer between its cabinet partner and the Sayap Kiri. Above all, the PNI thought of itself as the party of Indonesia’s President Sukarno, even though Sukarno had chosen to stand above party politics as one of Indonesia’s few non-partisan national leaders. While Sukarno attempted to avoid the fac tionalism which was rending Indonesia in 1948, wherever he led, the PNI would follow. At the beginning of 1948, a scattering of other political groups sprinkled the political horizon, including a splinter “PKI Merah” (Red PKI), which seems to have been of little consequence.34 One group, however, which was to have a great impact over the next six months was at the beginning of 1948 still repressed and scattered. Tan Malaka’s followers, the radical left-wing “national Communists,”35 or “Trotskyists” as the PKI termed them, were still either languishing in jail with Tan Malaka or were under close surveillance by Amir’s Sayap Kiri forces. In 1946, Tan Malaka had represented the only challenge on the left to the Sayap Kiri. A crisis between the two groups occurred in 1946 over the question of whether Indonesia should follow Tan Malaka’s path of guerrilla warfare against the Dutch or the “diplomasi” of the Sjahrir-Amir coalition. The Sayap Kiri carried the day and Tan Malaka and his followers landed in jail.36 While Tan Malaka was jailed in March 1946, neither the Sjahrir nor the Amir government seemed to have any desire to bring him or his followers to trial on charges many felt to have been trumped up.37* Both Amir’s Sayap Kiri and Indonesia’s right-wing politicians were well aware of the appeal of Tan Malaka’s radical nationalism, and the challenge he could thus present to Amir’s forces. At the beginning of 1948, several Tan Malaka-oriented lasykar or armed youth groups (e.g.
33 Kahili) “Some Aspects,” pp. 9-10, has a full discussion o f the PNI’s composition. Even under this center-left leadership, however, the PNI was more conservative in outlook than it was to become in the early 1950s. A lso see J. Eliseo Rocamora,”The Partai Nasional Indonesia, 1963-1965,” in Indonesia 10 (October 1970): 143. 34 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 87, gives one o f the fullest accounts o f this group. 35 Tan Malaka’s followers were a very mixed bunch, noted more for their radical nationalism than for any theoretical adherence to “communism,” although they themselves always insisted on the “Communist” label. They included such young left-wing radicals as Adam Malik and Pandu Karta Wiguna, and unclassifiable people like the Barisan Banteng’s Muwardi who was close to Sukarno. 36 Anderson, Java, Ch. 12,16, and Epilogue. 37 While som e o f Tan Malaka’s followers were involved in the July 3,1946, kidnapping o f Sjahrir, others, in cluding Tan Malaka himself, had been jailed prior to this event. Tan Malaka and som e o f these others were to be released in late 1948 for “lack o f evidence” {Benia Indonesia, September 16,1948, p. 1). While Sjahrir was certainly involved in Tan Malaka’s arrest, the PSI (Indonesian Socialist Party) later claimed this was done by Amir over Sjahrir’s protests; see Berita Indonesia, September 6,1948, p. 1.
12 Dr. Muwardi’s Barisan Banteng) were quietly waiting for the opportunity to gather Tan Malaka’s forces together again. The P oliticized M ilitary
Political parties, however, were not the only political forces on the scene in 1948. The army (TNI-Tentara Nasional Indonesia) and the armed youth groups (lasykar)?* some of which were mentioned above, represented very real sources of political power—power that was often out of the control of the civilian government or even the central army command. Efforts to bring some semblance of order to Indonesia’s fighting forces had been going on since the Republic’s inception, but without any great success. Both army and lasykar commanders tended to be powers unto themselves. This was especially true in late 1947, as the Republic returned to guerrilla fighting against the Dutch and decentralization was a necessity.39 In early 1948, there were two armed forces commands on Java: the TNI, or Indonesian National Army, of approximately 350,000 men40 and the lasykar, which were formally un der the TNI Masyarakat (People’s TNI), of 470,000 men.41 The reason behind the two command structures was essentially a political one. In 1946-1948, it would have been almost impossible politically to bring the individualistic and widely varying lasykar under strict TNI control; therefore, some form of looser coordinating organization was needed. Thus, the TNI Masyarakat structure, which was originally called the Biro Perjuangan (Resistance Bureau) was officially set up to coordinate the hundreds of independent stu dent fighting units. However, since the first Sjahrir Cabinet, Amir Sjarifuddin had held the Defense Ministry and it had perhaps been his most important weapon in trying to consolidate leftist power in the armed forces. Amir’s success in influencing or reorganiz ing the regular army structure under Sudirman had been minimal, but by using the sepa rate command for the lasykar he was able to increase leftist influence at least over portions of this segment of the armed forces. The high command of the TNI Masyarakat, which had representatives spread throughout Java, was directly responsible to the Indonesian defense minister (Amir) and was staffed almost entirely with loyal Amir socialists.42* The TNI Masyarakat was the basic unit of Amir’s people’s defense strategy, aimed at building a widespread guerrilla capability for Indonesia. It was disliked by non-socialists as a po tential second army in socialist hands and by the TNI leaders as a possible challenge to the
38 The lasykar were fighting units usually composed o f students or young men under the control o f local or, at times, national leaders. These units were often small and locally centered, but they could, like Bung Tom o’s BPRI (Insurgent Corps of the Republic of Indonesia), Isman’s TRIP (Student Army o f the Republic o f Indo nesia), or Pesindo, have wider bases. Their main common feature was independent leadership, often unre sponsive to government commands. 39 An interesting picture of the military commanders’ independent powers can be seen in US Consul Foote’s angiy observations on what he felt was the role o f General Sudirman (Commander-in-Chief of the TNI) and Sutomo (commander of one of the Surabaya lasykar—BPRI) in blocking agreements between the Republic and the Dutch in 1947. See F R U S1947\ vol. 6, pp. 952,958,968,984,1005,1050. 40 Abdul Haris Nasution, Tentara N asional Indonesia, vol. 2 (Jakarta: Sending Masa, 1968), p. 130. This Figure includes the Indonesian Navy (ALRI), but it seems in any event somewhat high. 41 Ibid. 42 Nasution, Tentara N asional Indonesia, vol. 1 (Jakarta: Jajasan Pustaka Militer, 1956), p. 283, has a descrip tion o f the Biro and Amir’s influence. A lso see Sutomo, Sesudah “M adiun” dan “G estapu” Lantas A pa? (Jakarta: Balapan, 1965), p. 11.
13 regular army’s authority.43 In reality, however, the TNI Masyarakat was little more than a paper organization. It had little control over units other than those already in the socialist camp (e.g. the Masyumi’s Hizbullah and Sabilillah, Isman’s TRIP, and Bung Tomo’s BPRI were not obedient to its orders).44 The TNI Masyarakat’s main source of power seems to have derived from its ability to channel funds to the lasykar, and there are indica tions that Amir did use this channel to get arms and money to Pesindo and other Sayap Kiri lasykar45 The other command structure of Java was the formal command of the Indonesian Na tional Army under General Sudirman. Composed in January 1948 of seven territorial divisions, the TNI appeared on paper to be very well organized. Again, however, division commanders tended to be powers unto themselves, and units had to be persuaded rather than commanded to obey orders. Moreover, the central command of the TNI under Sudirman tended to regard itself as independent from the control of the civilian govern ment. A reorganization of the army command structure, drawn up by Amir as minister of defense and “promulgated” by Sukarno on January 2, 1948, had to be quickly rescinded because of strident objections from Sudirman and others in his command.46 General Sudirman himself, the commander of the TNI, is an enigmatic figure, shrouded in the great myth which grew up about him after the revolution. An ardent na tionalist, but also very much a Central Javanese, Sudirman was often impatient with those who championed the tactics of negotiation and “diplomasi.” This led him to have cordial relations with the Tan Malaka forces at times when their desire for a radical anti-Dutch policy coincided with his.47 Sudirman, however, had no great fondness for Amir Sjarifuddin and seems to have carried on a running battle to stave off Amir’s attempts, through his control of the Defense Ministry, to politicize (i.e., propagandize) the TNI.48 On the other hand, Sudirman was very close to the Javanese leaders of the recalcitrant Solo command (see below), and during 1948 appears to have tried to calm tempers between the evacuated West Javanese of the Siliwangi command and the Central Javanese units. Sudirman, however, was quite ill throughout 1948 with tuberculosis, and this may have hindered his leadership of the army. Politics within the army command structure itself are difficult to sort out and seem, except in a few exceptional cases, to have been based more on client-patron relationships
43 Sec A. H. Nasution, Tentara N asional Indonesia, vol. 2 (Jakarta: Sending Masa, 1971), p. 18, for army lead ers’ views of the TNI Masyarakat. 44 Ibid., vol. 2, p. 112. When, for instance, a new cease-fire was declared after the signing of the Renville Agreements, it took an appeal from Sukarno to force the Hizbullah and Sabilillah to obey the cease-fire, and then mostly in word not deed; also see Sutomo, Sesudah M adiun, p. 11. 45 Nasution, Tentara N asional Indonesia, 2:18; also Sutomo, Sesudah M adiun, p. 11; and Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 260-61. 46 Nasution, Tentara N asional Indonesia, 2:130-33. This plan, known as Rencana Baharuddin, was to be used in only slightly different form by Hatta in 1948. Under it, the minister of defense was given full control over both the Department of D efense and the army, the army structure would be “simplified,” and the staff re duced. Sudirman objected, because, he said, it was unclear to whom he was responsible (i.e., the Chief of State or minister of defense). In reality, he probably suspected an attempt by Amir to cut his power. A s long as Amir held the Ministry of D efense, Amir was willing to have the lasykar integrated into the TNI; once he lost that ministry his viewpoint changed. 47 See Anderson, Java, ch. 16. 48 Nasution, Tentara N asional Indonesia, 2:18; Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 77.
14 than on ideology (see Chapter III). The two divisions commanded by Nasution (Siliwangi --West Java) and Gatot Subroto (Sunan Gunung Jati-W est Java/W est Central Java) were conservative and loyal to the Hatta government when it came to power. Nasution was close to Hatta, while Gatot Subroto was a follower of Sudirman.49 The Yogyakarta com mand, while not Moslem-oriented like the Siliwangi, was also loyal to the Hatta govern ment. The Solo division (Divisi IV-Senopati), on the other hand, was led by a popular general, Sutarto, who was radical in outlook and whose loyalty to the central government was often in question.50 The East Java regiments again, by dint of being far removed from the capital in Yogyakarta, were an uncertain commodity when called upon to fulfill orders not to their taste. A bove the Parties: President and Vice President
The role of two other men was of crucial importance in early 1948, although neither was affiliated with any party or organization. Although President Sukarno and Vice Presi dent Mohammad Hatta had not taken the front stage in Indonesian politics for the period of the Sjahrir and Amir parliamentary cabinets, they had been active behind the scenes and any major decision which lacked Sukarno’s support was unlikely to succeed. Sukarno, in his role as “National Leader of Indonesia,” had purposely set himself above party poli tics. As a Javanese, Sukarno’s eclectic brand of Indonesian populist socialism (Marhaenism) placed him closer on the spectrum to the Sayap Kiri than to the Masyumi, but his role during 1948 seems to have been that of a unifier, and he is found appealing again and again for national unity.51 Sukarno’s great national popularity, however, made his support absolutely crucial for the success of any major decision. Vice President Mohammad Hatta was the complete opposite of Sukarno. Respected rather than loved, Hatta appeared as the cool, clear-headed “administrator,” contrasting dramatically with Sukarno, the “solidarity maker.”52 Educated in Holland, Hatta returned to Indonesia in the 1930s to organize, with Sjahrir, the Club Pendidikan Nasional Indone sia (Indonesian National Education Club), which, until their arrest, competed with Sukarno’s Partindo.53* A Sumatran Minangkabau, H atta’s position as Vice President not only balanced Sukarno emotionally but also geographically by giving the important Suma tran region representation in the Republic’s Java-based government. Hatta, too, like Sukarno, stood above party politics. While he was later to earn a name as a fervent anti49 See Anderson, Java, p. 244, for Gatot Subroto’s relations to Sudirman. 50 Sutarto had opposed the Sjahrir-Amir attempts to control Solo’s social revolution in 1946, strongly support ing left-wing populist forces there. He was also sympathetic to the July 3rd kidnapping o f Sjahrir. See Anderson, /ova, ch. 15, p. 385. 51 Sukarno throughout 1948 was constantly touring both Java and Sumatra, making speeches and keeping his contact with the Indonesian masses vibrant and alive. No other Indonesian leader seems to have had the abil ity to appeal to Indonesians on all sides of the political spectrum as did Sukarno. During the Sjahrir and Amir cabinets, Sukarno’s relations had been cool with Sjahrir, but somewhat better with Amir, who was close to Sukarno in temperament and style. On the other hand, Amir’s relations with Hatta had always been strained, while Hatta’s dry didactic style drew him close to Sjahrir. 52 See Herbert Feith, The D ecline o f Constitutional Democracy in Indonesia (Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1962). 53 Partindo (Partai Indonesia—Indonesian Party) was formed in 1931 after Sukarno had been arrested and the PNI banned by the Dutch. After his release from prison in late 1931, Sukarno took over Partindo, only to be jailed again in 1933 (until his release by the Japanese in 1942). Sukarno did not again join a party during or after the war. See Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 92-94.
15 Communist, this may well have been a consequence of his experiences during 1948, rather than a preconceived idea early in 1948. Unlike Sukarno, Hatta, while widely respected, seems to have had little personal following on Java, and during the latter half of 1947 spent most of his time in Sumatra organizing the government there. A Setting fo r Conflict
\ The events of 1948 were played out in three principal cities of Republican-held Java: Yogyakarta and Solo in Central Java and Madiun in East Java. The distances were short: Yogya to Solo, about one hour by car; Solo to Madiun, two hours by car. The ideological differences, however, were great: Yogyakarta, a large city,54 was the capital of the Republic of Indonesia, and was con trolled by loyal government troops and by lasykar of the popular Sultan of Yogyakarta, a young aristocrat turned nationalist revolutionary. Solo, close to Yogyakarta in size,55 on the other hand, was traditionally the city of the opposition, in 1948 of the Sayap Kiri. The Sayap Kiri, however, held no monopoly there; not only was Solo the headquarters of Pesindo, it was also the center of the Sayap Kiri’s enemy, the Barisan Banteng (an armed lasykar loyal to Tan Malaka) and of the Masyumi’s Hizbullah. A gentle revolution in 1946 had taken power from the hands of Solo’s royal families, who, unlike Yogyakarta’s Sultan, had been unable to move with the times.56 Solo’s own Fourth Division was (as mentioned above) left leaning and not amenable to the TNI central command’s orders, and since 1947 Solo had been under an emergency mili tary government headed by Wikana, one of the leaders of Pesindo and a secret PKI mem ber. (This military government was removed in May 1948.57) In effect, Solo at the begin ning of 1948 was a tinder box of barely controlled competing factions which were to be come increasingly violent towards one other. Madiun, a small, provincial city,58was also a stronghold of the Sayap Kiri. It was a rail road repair center with a high proportion of industrial laborers, and the Sayap Kiri was very influential in their labor unions. It was in Madiun that the Sayap Kiri located its “Marx House” for the training of its cadre and where these cadre came for many of their meetings. On the other hand, Madiun also housed competing Masyumi and PNI organi zations and units of various non-Communist lasykar, such as Isman’s TRIP. As in Solo, the atmosphere was very tense and political kidnappings between competing groups was
54 Roth, “Jokja Journal,” p. 716, says Yogyakarta had swollen to a population o f about 900,000 during the revo lution. Population figures are not available for this period. However, in 1930, Yogyakarta had a population of 137,000 while Solo had 165,000 and Jakarta (Batavia), the capital, had 533,000. Volkstelling 1930, vols. 1 and 2 (Batavia: Landsdrukkerij 1933,1936). 55 Population figures are not available for Solo at this period, but Solo before the war was slightly larger than Yogyakarta (see note 54). 56 See Anderson, Java, ch. 15. 57 Sedjarah Diponegoro, p. 179. 58 Madiun in 1930 had a population o f a little over 12,000 ( Volkstelling 1930, vol. 3 [1934]). Located on the road and railroad lines from Yogyakarta/Solo to Surabaya, Madiun had some industry, but in comparison to Solo or Yogyakarta, the town was very small.
16 not uncommon.59 Other cities were also to play a role in the months to follow but none were as crucial as these three. Indonesia and the W orld
At the beginning of 1948, global international issues were of little concern to the Indo nesian leaders. Hemmed into their Central Javanese capital at Yogyakarta by the Dutch, the Republican leaders were primarily concerned, not with the beginnings of the Cold War in the West, but with how to win their own revolution. In their fight, the United States was regarded by all sides, including both Amir’s Sayap Kiri and the Masyumi, as a possible ally against the Dutch. Questions of broader Cold War allegiances were simply not raised. Tensions which did exist within the Indonesian Republic were primarily do mestic, and they were muted by the commonly felt need for unity against the greater threat represented by the Dutch. While there were distinct differences between the Sayap Kiri, the Masyumi, and to a lesser extent the PNI, they still found it possible to work together within one cabinet. The armed forces with their competing organizations and personali ties were a source of problems to any civilian government, but ones which were secondary as long as the armed forces were mainly focused on the war against the Dutch. In late 1947, however, the United States played a major role in bringing the Dutch and Indone sians to the floating conference table on the USS Renville in Jakarta Bay. The Renville Agreements which emerged from these meetings, while giving momentary hope that the basis for settlement of the problems between the Dutch and the Indonesians had been found, were to become the cause (or rather the excuse) for the beginning of the rift be tween radical and conservative forces in the Indonesian revolution which developed over the course of the following months. 59 M erdeka, September 22,1948, p. 3.
C hapter II I nto O pposition-T he B eginning
Consensus, or the art of giving everyone a slice, however small, of the ruling pie, is a time-honored method of Indonesian rule. Up to the beginning of 1948, the Sayap Kiri had played the game with the deft assurance of a diamond cutter, including almost all facets of Indonesia’s contending elite within its cabinet.1 While the Sayap Kiri never let the reins of command slip from its hands, the techniques of consensus rule encouraged a blurring of the edges of controversy and emphasized personal commitments over ideology. In No vember 1947, one of the first US “Southeast Asia experts” to be stationed in the US mis sion in Indonesia had this to say of the Republic: Although government based party system, it [is] clear parties lack real definition. Haziness of the principles and programs affect even Commu nist party. Discussion [with Indonesians in Yogyakarta] lead [to the] conclusion Government purely one of leaders with personal followings and that understanding of function [of] parties in representative govern ment scarcely exists. Enormous size present Cabinet (33 members last week, 37 now) indicates all boys must be taken care of. Fact not only limits Government’s ability act with expedition and decision but suggests unreadiness [to] deal with internal rivalries which might shatter coalition in the absence [of an] external foe, particularly since prerogatives public office will be main plums of independent Indonesia.2* The F all o f Sayap K iri
In early January 1948, the carefully built structure of political unity upon which the Sayap Kiri’s power rested began to crumble. The formal issue was the Amir cabinet’s decision to accept the Renville Agreements rather than face what it felt would be an inevi table Dutch attack. It quickly became apparent, however, that the Renville issue was
1 Tan Malaka’s followers, of course, had no role in the Indonesian government, and many in early 1948 were still in jail. 2 F R U S1947, vol. 6, p. 1072: Confidential cable from the Consul General at Batavia to the Secretary of State. The cable was sent by Charlton Ogbum, Jr., a foreign service officer and member of the Department’s Divi sion of Southeast Asian Affairs, who had been assigned to Dr. Graham’s staff on the U N Good Offices Com m ittee in October 1947. (Ogbum had previously served with Merrill’s Marauders in Burma during World War II.) When Ogbum wrote the cable, he had just returned from twelve days o f meetings in Yogyakarta with the Republic’s leaders. His cable is one of the first to show a balanced outlook on the Republic. The US Consu late General up to this point had been relatively uninformed on the internal workings of the Republic and ex ceptionally pro-Dutch in orientation.
17
18 being used by the Masyumi to gain a more prominent position in the Indonesian Republic’s government. On January 9, Vice President Hatta and Prime Minister Amir Sjarifuddin flew to Sin gapore to meet former Prime Minister Sjahrir who was returning to Indonesia after more than six months abroad. The two men probably hoped to convince Sjahrir to lend his considerable influence to their attempts to win agreement in Yogyakarta to the Renville proposals. Sjahrir, however, withheld his support on the grounds that international sym pathy was now with the young Republic and this was no time to give in to the Dutch.3 The Renville Agreements were rapidly becoming the source of heated controversy and, on January 15, the Masyumi announced its withdrawal from Amir’s cabinet because of its opposition to the agreements.4 Amir, however, probably hoping that he could hold the support of the more moderate PNI, proceeded to sign the Renville Agreements on Janu ary 17. His hopes proved false, for, on January 18, the PNI announced that it too was opposed to Renville. The PNI then called for the formation of a new cabinet, as Amir had now lost the confidence of the Republic’s two largest parties. Even as the PNI joined with the Masyumi to press for Amir’s resignation, it maintained its usual ambivalent policy by not withdrawing from Amir’s cabinet.5 Masyumi opposition to the Amir cabinet was much more important than its opposition to Renville.6 Masyumi tempers on Renville were quickly calmed by Dr. Graham, America’s representative on the UN Committee of Good Offices (GOC). Graham, who was very close to the Masyumi, immediately exerted his influence on the party’s leaders when their opposition to Renville became apparent.7 Graham’s arguments appear to have succeeded. While the Masyumi used Amir’s “weakness” and “mishandling” of Renville as a tactic in its campaign against his cabinet,8 within two days of their resignation from the cabinet, Masyumi leader Sjafruddin Prawiranegara announced that the Masyumi would
3 Berita Indonesia, January 10,1948, p. 1. 4 A neta, January 17,1948, p. 1; and Berita Indonesia, February 2,1948, p. 1. 5 M erdeka, January 20,1948, p. 1. In a statement issued January 22,1948, the Sayap Kiri was to denounce the Masyumi effort to bring down the Sjarifuddin government and express its puzzlement over the PNI position. For the text o f the Sayap Kiri statement, see Djamal Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun (Jakarta: Merdeka Press, 1966), pp. 32-34. 6 Berita Indonesia, February 2,1948, p. 1. According to the FDR, the Masyumi apparently put out a statement sometime before February 22 that the “first question” was to change the “weak” Amir government, Renville was only the “second question.” See Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 33. 7 See A neta N ews Bulletin, January 15,1948 and January 20,1948: Graham apparently arranged for Masyumi leaders Sukiman, Samsuddin, and Ki Bagus Hadikusumo to come to Jakarta for discussions with him between January 15 and 20. Close relations between Graham and the Masyumi leaders were also noted by Manai Sofian in his “Surat Dari Jokja” (M erdeka, February 11,1948, p. 4), “Many wonder about the close friendship between the Masjumi (especially Sukiman) and Graham___ It is no longer a secret that these two sides often meet without the knowledge of the government.” Graham’s efforts to bring the Masyumi into line on the Renville Agreements were later used by the USSR to charge that the United States had conspired with the Masyumi and PNI to bring about the downfall of Amir’s government. See McVey, Soviet View, pp. 38-39 for Pravda reports at the time and N ew Times, November 3,1948, p. 30 for the later version of this line which was to become part o f PKI and USSR history. In January 1948, however, Graham’s efforts appear to have been concentrated solely on helping to persuade the Masyumi not to oppose the Renville Agreements. Amir him self was the main Indonesian sponsor of these agreements and Graham was, in effect, supporting Amir rather than working against him. 8A neta, January 29,1948, p. 5; Berita Indonesia, February 16,1948, p. 3.
19 obey the Renville ceasefire.9 A week later, the Masyumi was to join the H atta cabinet, whose program required support for the implementation of the agreements. Amir finally resigned on January 23, in the face of strong PNI and Masyumi pressure, and Sukarno, appealing for unity, immediately appointed Hatta as formateur of a new gov ernment.10 Hatta, in turn, announced on January 24, his intention of setting up a presiden tial cabinet (i.e., one which would theoretically be responsible to the President rather than to the KNIP [Central Indonesian National Committee])11and stated firmly his intention to continue the policy of including all major political groupings in the cabinet.12 H atta’s failure to pull together a broadly based cabinet set the pattern of left-wing op position which led directly to Madiun. The reasons for this failure, however, are not immediately apparent. Although a Moslem Sumatran, H atta was not identified with any single political group. It was undoubtedly for this reason that he was appointed formateur by Sukarno, who, as usual, was trying to mend the developing rift between left and right. The main point of contention to arise in the formation of the cabinet was the disposition of the Defense Ministry. The Sayap Kiri was adamant that it be given the ministry, and the Masyumi was equally adamant in its opposition to the Sayap Kiri demands.13 In addition, H atta may have been under pressure from friends in the army (such as Nasution) who had no love for Amir and wished to check the growing “politicization,” i.e., left-wing influence, in the armed forces. In any case, Hatta seems to have been absolutely determined to remove the Ministry of Defense from Amir’s hands, and his final decision to keep the de fense portfolio for himself was probably an effort to keep party influence, left and right, out of the army. While H atta’s refusal to bend to Sayap Kiri’s demand for the Defense Ministry was crucial, non-inclusion of the left in H atta’s cabinet seems to have been due more to the decision of the left wing’s leaders not to join than to any intention by Hatta to exclude them. According to a Socialist Party statement of February 17, the party decided in a
9 M erdeka, January 19,1948, p. 1. 10 Ibid., January 24,1948, p. 1. It had been obvious since January 17 that Amir’s cabinet was in trouble, and this may account for the speed with which Sukarno was able to make the decision on a new formateur. 11 The KNIP (Komite Nasional Indonesia Pusat—Central Indonesian National Committee) was set up in 1945 as a temporary committee to assist the President and his cabinet in that period before a “People’s Congress” could be elected. Later in 1945, it was given legislative powers, and it continued to function on and off as a Parliament throughout the revolutionary period (see Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 139-40,152-53). While theoreti cally a presidential cabinet would not be responsible to the KNIP and thus not need a parliamentary majority, the cabinet which Hatta put together did, in any case, have a majority o f seats. Hatta as Vice President did not sit in the KNIP, so it was logical to have his cabinet a presidential one. In practice, o f course, he needed a par liamentary majority not only for legitimacy, but for day-to-day work. Kahin, N ationalism (p. 232), comments that the Hatta cabinet in practice “held itself accountable to the Working Committee o f the KNIP as well.” 12 M erdeka, January 6,1948, p. 1. 13 In demonstrations on January 24, the FDR made public this demand for the D efense Ministry (Ibid., Janu ary 26, 1948). According to Kahin, N ationalism (p. 232), the Sayap Kiri wanted a minimum o f four cabinet posts in all: besides D efense, they hoped for the Ministries of the Interior, Finance, and Foreign Affairs or Agriculture. The most important o f these posts was, o f course, the D efense Ministry which Amir had held without break since the first Sjahrir cabinet in 1946. Unfortunately, there is little indication in the press at the time of what Hatta was willing to offer the Sayap Kiri. However, as reported b y A neta (February 3, 1948), Hatta told reporters that Amir, Abdulmadjid, and Tjokronegoro had been offered seats but that the left-wing parties had not allowed their men to accept.
20 meeting held on January 26, not to agree to the formation of the Hatta government.14 The Sayap Kiri objected strongly in principle to the establishment of a presidential cabinet, which they felt took power away from the KNIP.15 Feelings also ran high in the Sayap Kiri over the role of the Masyumi in bringing down Amir’s cabinet, and press reports specu lated that one reason for the Sayap Kiri’s refusal to join was its objection to working in the same cabinet with the PNI and Masyumi.16 The Sayap Kiri probably also felt that its power was such that within the following weeks it could bring down the H atta government easily, or at least force inclusion of the Sayap Kiri in the government on terms more favor able than those now being offered. During the week of negotiations for the formation of the new cabinet, tensions and tempers soared throughout the Republic. Masyumi street demonstrations in Yogyakarta on the day that Amir announced his resignation were rumored to have been a reason for his cabinet’s fall.17 The Sayap Kiri promptly launched counter-demonstrations, starting off in Yogyakarta on January 24, with demands that Amir be included in any new government and that the Sayap Kiri be given at least the Defense Ministry.18 These demonstrations did not reach a real crescendo until after the announcement that the left wing would not par ticipate in the government. They seem, however, to have been enough to infuriate the legalistic Hatta, who plainly did not like to be pressured. On January 30, the day before the announcement of his new cabinet, Hatta strongly criticized the left wing. People who merely study Leninism/Stalinism but do not aid their government in the revolutionary struggle, he told a gathering of youth groups, certainly cannot be called revolutionaries. On the other hand, Kiayi (i.e., Moslems) who are willing to fight for their government are certainly nationalist revolutionaries.1920 No one, including Hatta, was satisfied with the basically Masyumi/PNI cabinet an nounced January 31,1948: Ministry® Prime Minister Defense Interior Foreign Affairs Justice Finance Economic Affairs Food Education and Culture
Name Mohammad Hatta Mohammad Hatta Sukiman Haji Agus Salim Susanto Tirtoprodjo A. A. Maramis Sjafruddin Prawiranegara Kasimo Ali Sastroamidjojo
Party Non-party Non-party Masyumi Non-party PNI PNI Masyumi Catholic Party PNI
14 Berita Indonesia, March 11,1948, p. 3 carries the text of the February 17 statement; also szzA n eta , February 3,1948. 15 Ibid. 16 Berita Indonesia, February 3,1948, p. 1. 17 M erdeka, February 12,1948, p. 1. 18 Ibid., January 26,1948, p. 1. 19 Ibid., February 2,1948, p. 1. 20 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 232.
21 Name
Party
Johannes Leimena Kiayi Haji Maskoer Koesnan Supeno Djuanda Mohammad Natsir Hamengku Buwono IX (Sultan of Yogyakarta)
Christian Party Masyumi PGRI (Teacher Union) PSI Non-party Masyumi Non-party
Ministry Health Religion Social Affairs Reconstruction and Youth Communications Information Without portfolio
While the Defense and Foreign Affairs Ministries were held by independents Hatta and Haji Agus Salim, the other top priority ministry, Interior, was in Masyumi hands as were the Ministries of Economic Affairs, Information, and Religion. Because of this composition and the exclusion of the Sayap Kiri, the Hatta cabinet was considered by most observers (other than the Masyumi) to be too conservative. Some also charged it with being “America minded” because of the close relations between Graham and the Masyumi.21 The cabinet was thus seen as a temporary one which would continue only until a new unity among the parties could be forged.22 Dissatisfaction with the cabinet is proba bly best summarized in a prophetic editorial by Berita Indonesia on February 5: We are more afraid that a power struggle may arise later between the left-wing opposition and the right-wing government, [especially] if the Hatta cabinet fails to seek a compromise with the left wing and bases its power only on reactionary-conservative elements. We fear this will cause the rise of a power struggle in the future which on one side will be of a dictatorial nature and on the other, non-cooperative. . . . For the welfare of our country, we can easily reflect on incidents which arise in other parts of the world.23 The successful Masyumi toppling of Amir’s government and two weeks of demonstra tions and counter-demonstrations seem to have created a new bitterness between the Masyumi and Sayap Kiri, where only a deep distaste and mutual distrust had existed be fore. Differences between the two, which had been intentionally muted in the past, were, in the weeks that followed January 31, to be thrown into increasingly sharp relief. Hatta and General Sudirman tried to calm tempers by banning mass demonstrations of the type which flared in East and Central Java to demand Amir’s return,24*but while they succeeded in reestablishing order almost immediately, the rift continued to widen.
21 Manai Sofian, “Surat dan Jokja”; M erdeka, February 14, 1948, p. 4; and A neta, February 4, 1948 quoting Sumber, Yogyakarta newspaper. 22 M erdeka, February 16, 1948, p. 1; and FBIS, February 2, 1948, quoting Yogyakarta radio. Hatta himself promised that his cabinet was only temporary and would be changed as soon as possible. 23 Berita Indonesia, February 5,1948, p. 3. 24 Bintang M erab, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 40. According to this PKI publication, Sayap Kiri demonstra tions brought out 100,000 people in Madiun, 75,000 in Magetan, and 5,000 in Ponorogo and Ngawi. Sukarno, during a trip to East Java (Kediri, Blitar, Jombang, Madiun) from January 30 to February 3, was also met by demonstrations demanding Amir’s return (Berita Indonesiaf February 5,1948, p. 2). Radio Gelora Pemuda in Madiun, a Sayap Kiri radio, threatened widespread demonstrations if Amir was not included in the govern ment (Berita Indonesia, February 3,1948, p. 1; K engPo, February 3,1948, p. 1).
22
Form ation o f the L oyal O pposition
On February 3, Hatta installed his cabinet and announced the four-point program which was to form its guidelines: implementation of the Renville Agreements; accelera tion of the formation of the United States of Indonesia; rationalization of the Republic’s army and economy; and reconstruction.25 H atta then told the press that all the parties, including the Sayap Kiri, had accepted his program but that the Sayap Kiri, while support ing Renville, would remain in opposition.26 In the weeks that followed, the Sayap Kiri, which was now being called by a formerly little-used name, “Front Demokrasi Rakyat” (FDR—People’s Democratic Front),27was to corroborate Hatta’s statement that the FDR supported Renville and to add that its opposition was “loyal and constructive.”28 The FDR, however, apparently felt that there was no contradiction between being a “loyal and constructive” opposition and continuing its all-out attack on the Masyumi in an effort to bring down H atta’s government. In an emergency session on February 20-21, the FDR came out firmly against the idea of H atta’s presidential cabinet, but issued a decision that it was willing to aid in carrying out the Renville Agreements.29 Support of Renville but opposition to the Hatta cabinet was to continue to be the basic FDR policy through Au gust 1948. Amir, in explaining this policy to a Solo branch meeting on February 25, hotly denied the accusation that the FDR’s policy was “destroying national unity.”30 By this time, however, the FDR was already doing its best to split the PNI and Masyumi. On February 16, FDR parliamentarians attacked the Masyumi for causing Amir’s fall, and by February 20, the FDR had launched frontal attacks on the new Masyumi minister of social welfare, Sjafruddin Prawiranegara, calling him a defender of capitalism.3132 These attacks were evidently continued and increased through March and April as FDR leaders took to the field to explain their positions. By March 20, Amir himself had spoken to twenty-six
25 Berita Indonesia, February 5,1948, p. 2; and Kahin, N ationalism , p. 234. 26 Berita Indonesia, February 5,1948, pp. 2-3; and^lneto, February 3,1948, p. 1. 27 A t what point the Sayap Kiri started using the name Front Demokrasi Rakyat (FD R ) is something of a mystery. Kahin, N ationalism , p. 259, dates the formal change to a meeting in Solo on February 26,1948. The “Maklumat Sayap Kiri” issued January 21,1948, however, was already signing itself Front Demokrasi Rakyat (Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 34) and on February 21,1948, Berita Indonesia notes that the Sayap Kiri had changed its name to Front Demokrasi Rakjat. 28 PKI member Luat Siregar, for instance, in the name o f the FDR, told Parliament on February 16 that in principle the FD R agreed with the four-point program of the government and that the FD R ’s opposition would be “sehat dan korektif [healthy and corrective].” Berita Indonesia, February 18,1948, p. 3. Earlier, on January 29, another Sayap Kiri leader had told a Reuter’s correspondent that the Sayap Kiri intended to carry out a “constructive and loyal opposition” in the Working Committee of the Parliament {FBIS, January 30, 1948, from Batavia radio, in English, January 29). 29 M erdeka, March 3,1948, p. 2. 30 KengPo, February 27,1948, p. 1. K engPo, quoting A ntara, says the Solo meeting took place on Wednesday, February 25, 1948. The meeting caused so little stir that accounts of it do not appear in other newspapers available in the Cornell Library (and A ntara o f the period is not available). Most secondary sources discussing Madiun quote Kahin, N ationalism , p. 259, who states that according to A ntara this meeting took place Febru ary 26,1948. These secondary sources often go on to see February 26 as a major turning point in FD R history when the Sayap Kiri formally took on this new name and then turned against the Renville Agreements (see Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 29 and Brackman, Indonesian Communism, p. 72 for examples). 31 M erdeka, February 18,1948, p. 1; A neta, February 20,1948, p. 1. 32 FBIS, March 24,1948, quoting Yogyakarta Radio, March 23,1948.
23 mass meetings while touring East and Central Java.32 Amir apparently attacked the Masyumi, and specifically Sukiman as minister of the interior, but conspicuously left the PNI alone.33 Through the beginning of May, then, the FDR seems to have played a conventional (if vociferous) role as opposition party. Its aim was to weaken the government and to force either, at the maximum, the formation of a new government under its leadership, or, at the minimum, its inclusion in the government on its own terms. This opposition role was re stricted almost entirely to domestic issues. The results of the FDR’s party congress in Yogyakarta on April 24-26 read like a left-wing panacea for all ills. The congress called for the government to remove harsh taxes, to free the farmer from feudalistic controls and imperialist influences, to guarantee the right to strike, to supply cheap medicine and doc tors to the people, and to increase the fight against world capitalism. On foreign affairs, the meeting called for increased relations “with those nations that are free of capitalism” (i.e., the socialist camp), but while its leaders might berate the Dutch, the FDR did not cease to support negotiations with the Dutch on the basis of Renville.34 While FDR opposition to the Masyumi was noisy, it appears to have remained totally in legal channels. (Only one strike was reported by the press through April, the municipal waterworkers in Solo. This was apparently not politically motivated, as it failed to raise any comment.35) By April, however, rumors of nefarious FDR plans to bring down the government were already abroad, spread by the Sayap Kiri’s old enemy, the Tan Malaka radical nationalists. Tan Malaka’s followers had been very quiet under Amir, but they seem to have taken on a new lease on life under the Hatta cabinet. At this early period, it is unclear what, if any, encouragement they were receiving from Hatta or other elements in his government. The Tan Malaka forces, however, were well-known enemies of Amir. It would seem a bit more than coincidence that the minute the Amir government fell, announcements were issued that, at long last, the Tan Malaka followers arrested before and at the time of, the July 3rd affair would be brought to trial.36 By the beginning of April, those Tan Malaka forces still free had re-formed themselves into the Gerakan Revolusi Rakyat (G R R -People’s Revolutionary Movement) under the leadership of the Barisan Banteng’s Dr. Muwardi and were publishing in Solo a paper called Murba. On April 1, in the midst of a series of sensational but rather scurrilous attacks, Murba printed what it purported to be a FDR February 5 directive to its branches giving instructions for a
33 Manai Sofian, “Surat Dari Jokja,” M erdeka, April 10,1948, p. 2; also see John Sutter, Indonesianisasi (Ith aca, NY: Cornell Southeast Asia Program, 1959), p. 555. Amir’s strategy, according to Sofian, was to attack Sukiman as minister of the interior for various “belasting” (taxes) such as land rent, import taxes, etc. Accord ing to Sofian, attacks by FD R leaders Setiadjit (PBI) and Maruto Darusman (PKI) against Sukiman were par ticularly offensive and rude. 34 Beriia Indonesia, May 4,1948, p. 1; M erdeka, May 17,1948, p. 1; Berita Indonesia, May 20,1948, p. 1; Berita Indonesia, June 12,1948, p. 1, quoting A neta interview with Amir Sjarifuddin. 35 FBIS, April 8,1948, quoting A ntara Radio from Yogyakarta; K engP o, April 9,1948, p. 1 and April 13,1948, p. 2. 36M erdeka, January 29,1948, p. 1. Tan Malaka in his D ariPendjara ke Pendjara, vol. 3 (Jakarta: Widjaja, n.d.), p. iii, says that he was detained until February 1948 without ever having charges brought against him: “Only in the beginning o f February 1948, i.e., after almost two years in jail, was I faced again with the question of my imprisonment through the medium of the Deputy Attorney General.” (A lso see ibid., p. 123.) Hatta’s intense sense o f legality may also have had a part in the swiftness with which justice moved after he took over the cabi net.
24 new FDR strategy.37 The alleged FDR document stated the FDR could never join the H atta cabinet because it was Masyumi controlled and it is clear “that communism is unal terably opposed to Islam.” The document then went on to outline the methods the FDR would use to topple the Hatta government, which, if necessary, would include distur bances, kidnappings, and thievery to break the people’s confidence in the Hatta government’s ability to maintain security.38 The Murba story was immediately denied by the FDR and the case sent to the Attorney General for investigation.39 Although the H atta government itself did not seem to take Murba's charges very seriously, Murba's campaign against the FDR raised suspicions about the FDR’s intent which were to take deep root in the coming months. The S ocialist Camp Splits
The two wings of the Socialist Party had lived together in an uneasy truce since Sjahrir’s ouster in July 1947. As General Simatupang later remarked, in the Sayap Kiri, Amir provided the motor and driving power, and Sjahrir was the driver.40 With Sjahrir away, the Socialist Party was deprived of its brakes and moved steadily to the left.41 The Sjahrir socialists were increasingly uneasy under Amir’s leadership, but problems did not come to a head until Sjahrir’s return on January 11. Relations between Amir and Sjahrir had soured after Amir’s opposition brought down the Sjahrir cabinet. On his return, Sjahrir immediately opposed Amir, first by criticizing the Renville Agreements and then by demanding that the socialists support rather than oppose the Hatta government.42 On February 12, shortly after the Socialist Party’s decision not to join the H atta government, the Sjahrir socialists announced they were withdrawing from the Socialist Party to set up a
37 Muhammad Dimyati, Sedjarah Perdjuangan Indonesia (Jakarta: Widjaja, 1951), p. 172; and Manai Sofian, “Surat dari Jokja,” M erdeka, April 10,1948, p. 2. The author unfortunately has been unable to locate any is sues of M urba, and the only accounts of the M urba article available are those of Dimyati and Manai Sofian. While I have been unable to locate the text o f the “Murba document/* it seems clear from Sofian and Dimyati’s descriptions o f the text that this is the same document which Kahin says is an “11-point document made public by the Republican government just after the beginning of the Communist rebellion and consid ered to be in part (point 11) a fabrication by some persons hostile to the FDR** (Kahin, N ationalism , p. 269). This 11-point document (see Appendix A ) was also used by Sukarno in his radio address to the nation on Sep tember 19,1948 (Appendix B). A t that time, Sukarno quoted point 11 to show that since February the FDR had been planning illegal actions. 38 Ibid. 39 M erdeka, April 10,1948, p. 2; and Mirajadi “Tiga Tahun,*’ pp. 46-47. Mirajadi in his BintangM erah article stated that not only had the FD R Central Secretariat (Yogyakarta) put out in various papers a denial o f this document, but that its Solo branch had given testimony to the police in the matter of M urba's publication o f the “false document.** But, says Mirajadi, strangely the police in Solo took no action against the forgers o f the false document. Mirajadi’s implication is that the government both in Yogyakarta and locally had no desire to punish the wrongdoers. After his capture in November 1948, Amir gave an interview to the Catholic paper, H idup, in which he also denied the authenticity of the document and pointed out that he had brought the case not only to the attorney general but to President Sukarno himself. The papers, Amir charged, were a GRR forgery (H idup, December 18,1948, p. 3). M urba, however on September 29,1948, denied it had forged the documents and as proof pointed to the fact that no action had been taken against it. 40 T. B. Simatupang, Laporan dari Banaran (Jakarta: Pembangunan, 1959), pp. 93-95. See also the translation of this by Benedict Anderson and Elizabeth Graves, Report from Banaran: Experiences During the People’s War (Ithaca: Cornell M odem Indonesia Project, 1970), p. 79, where the phrase is rendered “Bung Amir as the mo tor and Bung Sjahrir as the rudder of our ship of state.” 41 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,** p. 129. 42 Berita Indonesia, March 11,1948, p. 5.
25 new organization which would be called the Partai Sosialis Indonesia (Indonesian Socialist Party) or PSI as it soon came to be known.43 While the bitter feelings between Amir and Sjahrir, the loss of control of the Socialist Party to the Amir socialists, and the question of whether or not to support the Hatta cabinet were all factors in the Sjahrir socialists’ deci sion to pull out of the Socialist Party, the decision also seems to have been based upon major ideological differences.44 Immediately after Sjahrir’s return to Indonesia, a set of proposals were put before the Politbureau of the Partai Sosialis making suggestions for changes in the party’s organiza tion and discussing foreign policy questions. The proposals stated that Indonesia should not take sides with the US or USSR in the Cold War but should join with India and other newly independent countries in forming a third force.45 While these proposals were signed by Wirjono, a Sjahrir follower, it is evident that they were inspired, if not drafted, by Sjahrir. Up to this point the rising “Cold W ar” between the US and the USSR does not seem to have been an issue within Socialist Party ranks. The party was mainly concerned with domestic Indonesian issues and Amir himself during his tenure had cooperated closely with the Americans on the Renville Agreements. Sjahrir, however, had just re turned from more than six months abroad (mainly in Europe and the United States) and was probably far more conscious of the “Cold War” and its implications for Indonesia than was Amir, who during the same period had traveled no further afield than Sin gapore.46 While the Sjahrir socialists were to date the split in Socialist Party ranks on for eign policy as far back as March 1947,47*it seems quite clear that it was Sjahrir who on his return in 1948 sharpened his followers’ awareness of Cold War issues and galvanized them into action. By raising the Cold War issue within the Socialist Party ranks, Sjahrir also forced the Amir socialists to reconsider their policies and to take a public stand on the issue of Cold War allegiances. Differences between the two socialist groups emerge very clearly in the battle of state ments which occurred immediately after the Sjahrir socialists withdrew from the Partai Sosialis. In its “Maklumat” issued February 12,1948, the new PSI devoted most of its time to a discussion of the world situation. Asia, the PSI said, must guard its independence 43 Ibid., February 13,1948, p. 3. 44 For a discussion o f the various aspects of this decision, see L. Umar Santoso, “The Birth of the Socialist Party,” in ibid., February 17,1948, p. 4. 45 The “Wirjono proposals” were never published. In a statement issued February 17,1948 (Berita Indonesia, March 11,1948, pp. 3 and 5) the Partai Sosialis (Amir) stated they were basically the same as the statement published by the Sjahrir socialists (PSI) on February 12 (ibid., February 24,1948, p. 3; see discussion of Febru ary 12 statement in text). The PS also charged that before the Politbureau had had time to discuss W iijono’s proposals, they had been illegally circulated in the Socialist Party, causing a great deal o f confusion. The “Wirjono proposals” seem to have been a last ditch effort by the Sjahrir socialists to regain influence in the party. It was evidently apparent that they would be rejected by the Amir socialists. PSI members were later to claim that their decision to leave the PS had been made as they were fearful the stronger Amir social ists would use the “Wirjono proposals” as an excuse to purge them from the party at an upcoming congress in April. 46 A s pointed out in Chapter I Sjahrir had traditionally been the diplomat o f the Sjahrir/Amir duumvirate and hence far more attuned to foreign affairs. Amir, on the other hand, was a radical nationalist, far more at home in the nationalist circles in Yogyakarta than in the cosmopolitan atmosphere o f Jakarta. 47 “Maklumat Partai Sosialis Indonesia” (February 12,1948), in Berita Indonesia, February 24,1948, p. 3. A c cording to Subadio (PSI) in an unpublished work on the PSI, Sjahrir first became aware o f the differences be tween Communist Party lines on foreign policy and those of nationalist (non-Communist) leaders at an InterAsian Conference in March 1947 in India.
26 from the influence of American capital and also from the politics of the Soviet bloc. The Republic should, therefore, ally itself with other Asian countries and extricate itself from “ties which are too close to US capitalistic or Soviet politics.”48 On February 17, the Politbureau of the Partai Sosialis replied to the PSI attack. In a statement remarkably close to the Zhdanov line, the Partai Sosialis pointed to the world struggle between US capitalism and the socialism of the USSR and the “new East European democracies.” The new countries in Asia were a result of this struggle in Europe, and the idea that one could remain neutral in this struggle as suggested by Sjahrir was nonsense, the party contended. The Partai Sosialis statement, however, stopped short of demanding that Indonesia side solely with the socialist camp.49 The results of the PSI withdrawal from the Socialist Party were not immediately appar ent. The Sjahrir socialists were a small group of intellectuals without the mass following of Amir, and their departure did not cause a dramatic weakening of Socialist Party support. The PSI did, however, control many of the Socialist Party’s Sumatran branches, and their members held the leadership positions in the farmers’ organization, BTI. Also, through the efforts of their minister for youth, Supeno, they were in a position to try to break the left-wing hegemony in Pesindo. The PSI, however, made no effort to attract mass support away from the FDR. It preferred, rather, to remain an elitist organization in the months that followed, avoiding the rough and tumble politicking of the FDR and Masyumi and concentrating on education of its own small following.50 The Calcutta Conference, N ationalism , and the C old War
Although the split in the Socialist Party had brought to light the ideological differences between the radical Socialist/PKI approach to foreign policy and that of the Sjahrir “na tionalists,” the quarrel remained on a purely theoretical level within the socialist group. At this time, the question of the Republic’s relations with the Soviet Union and Eastern Europe was simply a non-issue among Indonesia’s other political parties. The Soviet Union was generally viewed as a friendly power for its strong defense of the Republic at the UN, and the Eastern European countries were also seen as friendly anti-imperialist forces. Russian control over its satellites only started to become a real issue after the Communist seizure of power in Czechoslovakia in late February 1948. Indonesia had an “information center” in Czechoslovakia, and while the Amir government had made secret overtures for recognition by the USSR and the bloc countries, this was not generally known. (See Chapter III below.) The USSR had no representatives in Indonesia, al though a Tass correspondent did visit the Republic in March.51* 48 Ibid. 49 Ibid., March 11, 1948, pp. 3 and 5. The Partai Sosialis does not at this point seem to have been anti-US. Amir had been working very closely with the Americans, especially Graham, on Renville. Kahin, N ationalism , p. 274, says Amir’s disillusionment with the US did not come until later in the year when it became clear that the United States was doing little to force the Dutch to implement Renville. It is doubtful that Amir would have been aware at this point that the USSR was charging that Graham helped to topple Amir’s cabinet, or that Amir would have believed this line. (A lso see McVey, Soviet View, pp. 39-40.) 50 Berita Indonesia, June 11,1948, p. 2. Sjahrir himself stated that the PSI would not join any new cabinet (in June) because it did not wish to become involved in intra-party fights. The PSI would keep its organization small and city-centered. 51 Unfortunately, little is known about Tass correspondent Afrin, who seems to have been in Indonesia only briefly. A s a Tass correspondent he was working for the Russian government in any case, and he may possibly have been a KGB agent. He undoubtedly contacted PKI leaders during his visit to Yogyakarta in March, but
27 In the late 1940s and early 1950s, the idea became popular among some W estern writ ers that the string of Communist revolutions which occurred during 1948 in Southeast Asia were sparked by specific orders from Moscow passed on to Asian Communist leaders at an Asian youth conference held in Calcutta, February 19-25, 1948. This thesis has many variations. The basics, however, are that the new Moscow (Zhdanov) line of a two-camp (Socialist/USSR and Imperialist/US) world and an order for revolution were communi cated to the Southeast Asian Communist parties in late February and early March of 1948 through the Calcutta meeting, and that all the Southeast Asian parties immediately fell into step. This “Calcutta Conference” thesis has been sufficiently refuted by Ruth M cV e/s writings, which show that both the context and the timing of the Calcutta confer ence made it an exceedingly unlikely forum for the passing of “orders from Moscow.”52 The 1947 Zhdanov line did represent a new orientation in Communist doctrine, but the question of when and how the line reached Indonesia and when it was accepted by the local Communists has remained a puzzle for historians. The tone of the FDR’s February 17 statement seems to indicate some knowledge of the two-camp line, and by May 1, the full text of Zhdanov’s famous speech to the Cominform (September 1947) had been translated and printed by the Communist press in Yogyakarta.53 Whatever their theoretical knowledge of the new Soviet line, however, the FDR and PKI gave little indication through May that they felt it had any practical meaning for their organizations in Indonesia. The USSR itself at this time, while criticizing the Renville Agreements,54 refrained from open attacks on the H atta government.55 FDR decisions on foreign and domestic policy seemed to follow from purely domestic causes, and even the PKI itself as late as June showed little indication of being in step with the world Communist line. In an interview with Daniel Schorr, quoted in Berita Indonesia, June 8,1948, Alimin told Schorr that Indonesia was not yet ready for socialism and that the left-wing parties must aid the government in its hour of crisis. Alimin said the PKI was
he does not seem to have been carrying any official word. His few public statements are tantalizing. On April 2,1948, Berita Indonesia (p. 2) carried anA ntara report of Afrin’s comments that Indonesia was almost totally controlled by the Dutch, and Brackman, Indonesian Communism (p. 2), notes that on his return to Jakarta from Yogyakarta, Afrin commented that the forces o f “counterrevolution” were in control in the Republic. The Dutch apparently considered Afrin a threat, as they expelled him from Indonesia on his return to Jakarta (FBISf March 12,1948, reporting an A ntara Radio Broadcast March 12,1948). 52 Ruth T. McVey, The Calcutta Conference an d the Southeast A sian Uprisings (Ithaca, NY: Cornell M odem Indonesia Project, 1958). A lso see McVey, “Southeast Asian Insurrectionary Movements” and Soviet View. The Indonesian delegates to the Calcutta conference seem to have had little effect on the PKI’s thinking. They were relatively low-level members of the PKI and, in any case, they did not arrive back in Java until som e time after late May (Berita Indonesia, May 7,1948, p. 3). On May 4, the first o f the Calcutta conference delegates (Samsu Anwar) arrived back in Bukittinggi, Sumatra. The main young PKI delegates, Francisca Fangiday, the chairman o f the delegation, Supeno (Pesindo) and Otto Rondonuwu (affiliation unknown) did not return until later. Little information was carried by the press on the Calcutta conference itself. On March 30, Berita Indo nesia (p. 4) carried a Tass story simply stating that the conference had called for “hands off A sia.” 53 A . Zhdanov, Situasi P olitik Intem asional (Yogyakarta: Mingguan Revolusioner, May 1948). The text o f the Zhdanov speech pointed to Indonesia (under Amir) and Vietnam as examples o f countries where the line was being carried out properly. The FD R was probably aware that Hatta’s government was not seen as favorably as Amir’s by the USSR, although the USSR refrained from criticizing Hatta. 54 Berita Indonesia, February 28,1949, p. 2; the paper speculates that Gromyko, who stated Russian dissatisfac tion with Renville at a U N session on February 18, might use the USSR veto against a vote praising the GOC’s work. On February 29, however, Gromyko abstained on this vote. A lso see Berita Indonesia, February 19, 1948, p. 1, and March 1,1948, p. 1. 55 McVey, Soviet View, p. 47.
28 even willing to see Indonesia accept US aid as long as it did not give the US too much control over the Republic’s economy.56 Some writers on Indonesia have charged that FDR policy underwent a drastic change in the two weeks between February 26 and early March to a repudiation of the Renville Agreements, a call for the cessation of all negotiations with the Dutch until after they had withdrawn from Indonesia, plus a generally harder line on nationalization of Dutch and other foreign property.57 From this, the conclusion has been drawn that in late February as a result of the Calcutta conference, the Indonesian Communist Party, both as a legal party and through its control of the FDR, started to fall in line with the harsher Moscow International Communist line. This thesis is difficult to support, however, as there is little evidence that in fact there was any major change in FDR policy from mid-January to midMay of 1948.58 Through early August, indeed, the FDR was to continue to support Renville as a basis for talks, although its public stance towards the Dutch became more hostile as the months went by.59 In this, it was not alone. Most of Indonesia’s political parties and leaders be came increasingly disenchanted with the possibilities for negotiations with the Dutch, and Republican tempers rose. Although the Dutch had agreed to hold plebiscites in the areas they had seized from the Republic, almost immediately after the signing of the Renville Agreements they proceeded to set up, without properly supervised plebiscites or consulta tions with the Republic, new states in Madura (January 21,1948) and West Java (February 26,1948), and finally an interim United States of Indonesia on March 9,1948. The Dutch effort to isolate the Republic from support in other areas of Indonesia and to revive re gional hostilities against a “Javanese” Republic was evident to all.60 Republican sentiment was unanimous in condemning the Dutch, and even the calm-tempered H atta was forced to protest the Dutch attempt to “deride” the Republic and to “flout Renville.”61* Feeling ran particularly high against those Indonesians who were working with the Dutch in the “puppet” governments. When the UN Good Offices Committee, accompa nied by the Dutch negotiating team and some of the leading Indonesian officials from the
56 Berita Indonesia, June 8,1948, p. 2. Berita Indonesia is quoting a Dutch newspaper and the date of this inter view, which was either late May or early June, is unknown. 57 See, e.g., Kahin, N ationalism , p. 260. 58 Dutch propaganda agencies may have attempted to give the impression that Amir was trying to sabotage Renville. There is only one mention, however, of this line in the Indonesian press at the time. On April 21, 1948, K engPo carried a story that J. H. Ritman, the head o f the Foreign Affairs section o f the RVD (the Dutch information service) in Jakarta, told newsmen in Holland that Hatta was now pro-Renville and Amir was antiRenville. 59 On May 20,1948, Berita Indonesia carried an FD R statement condemning the amnesty granted to Indone sians working for the Dutch. However, a few days later, Haijono, the PKI leader of SOBSI, stated that one way to win the revolution was through negotiations, but “Renville” is as far as SOBSI was willing to go (ibid., May 22,1948, p. 2). Moreover, SOBSI, which had earlier (April 26) sent a memo to the Indonesian delegation to the Renville talks which took a mild stand on foreign investments (“these can be worked out later”) went on to have a successful meeting with Hatta on the same subject on May 23 (ibid., April 27,1948, p. 1, and May 29, 1948, p. 3). Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri” (p. 36) says that Amir, as head of the FDR in March and April, stated his readiness to help in the implementation of Renville. 60 See FBIS, February 4 and February 13,1948, quoting Radio Jogjakarta. A lso see Berita Indonesia, February 27,1948, p. 1, for Ali Sastroamidjojo’s statements at the UN. 61 FBIS} February 24,1948, quoting Batavia radio broadcast of February 23 and FBIS, March 1,1948, quoting Radio Jogjakarta broadcast o f a Hatta speech of February 28.
29 Dutch-held areas, arrived at Yogyakarta’s Tugu railroad station on April 12, they were met by hostile demonstrators. While no one was hurt, delegates, especially the Indone sians, were cursed, spat upon, and generally abused. The Dutch promptly protested these indignities as a serious breach of diplomatic protection for the negotiations. Republican apologies were quickly forthcoming, but the Dutch continued to grumble about inade quate police protection, to complain that the Republic’s apologies were less than sincere, and to insinuate that the incidents had been “specially organized.”62 Press accounts of the time give little indication of who started the demonstrations, which apparently began with a small group of protestors whose ranks were swelled as interested spectators gathered at the station to await the long overdue train.63 More important than the actual origins of the demonstration is the fact that most Republican leaders seem to have sympathized with the sentiments of the crowd, embarrassing though it might be to the Republic at the level of world diplomacy. Haji Agus Salim, conservative Moslem leader and foreign minister, even told the PKI newspaper Buruh in an interview then quoted over the official Yogyakarta radio that the “Tugu Incident” could be excused by the Dutch if they would remember their own feelings toward Dutch traitors who collaborated with the Germans in World War II.64 Through the beginning of May, then, it seems to have been nationalism and a growing impatience with the Dutch, rather than any adherence to Communist Cold War doctrine, which motivated the FDR and the Communist Party. By May of 1948, only the first dim rumblings of the Cold War in Southeast Asia had reached Indonesia. Among the politi cians, only the Sjahrir socialists seem to have been aware of the conflicts that Russiancontrolled Communist doctrine could cause between domestic Communist parties and nationalist movements. In their writings and speeches, Sjahrir and other PSI leaders fol lowed events in Burma closely and gave veiled warnings of what might happen if the na tionalist movement split into warring left and right.65 There was in Indonesia a growing awareness of the forward thrust of Russian communism in Europe, especially after the Gottwald takeover in Czechoslovakia on January 26,1948; but it was not until mid-May that stories started to appear in the Indonesian press that the USSR was about to set up a new Comintern for Asia in Bangkok.66 Even as the first awareness of the potential of Communist revolutionary movements started to enter the Republic, its impact was dulled by the fact that Indonesia’s Communist Party seemed small and harmless. In addition, by this time most Indonesians were accustomed to ignoring strident Dutch propaganda that
62 Ibid., April 16,1948, quoting Batavia radio. 63 Berita Indonesia, April 14, 1948, p. 1; April 15,1948, p. 2; and April 17,1948, p. 2. The Dutch at first inti mated that the government had a hand in the demonstrations (FBIS, April 16,1948); then a broadcast on April 22,1948, over Radio Hilversum carried “rumors” that Amir and the FD R had been behind the demonstrations which were aimed at disrupting the Masyumi and causing chaos (ibid., April 22,1948). Brackman in Indone sian Communism also assumes the FD R started the Tugu Station incident (p. 73). Amir, however, had just arrived back in Yogyakarta with Hatta the day before, and one wonders if he had the time or inclination to start the demonstration (Berita Indonesia, April 12,1948, p. 1). The Sultan of Yogyakarta went so far as to intimate for his part that the demonstrations were instigated by Dutch agents in an effort to blacken the Republic’s international image. (Ibid., April 16,1948, p. 2.) 64 FBIS, April 16,1948, quoting A ntara from Yogyakarta. 65 Siasat, May 23,1948, pp. 10-11, carries a stoiy on the Burmese Communist Party rebellion. Berita Indonesia, February 18, 1948, p. 3, says that Sjahrir in a speech pointed to the problems occurring in other countries, China, Burma, and Vietnam, where the independence movement was split. 66 M erdeka, May 22,1948, p. 1, carried one o f the first rumors that a Comintern might be set up in Bangkok.
30 the Republic was in imminent danger of a Communist takeover. By June, this attitude would start to change and the lines of the Cold War struggle would start to take on domes tic significance. At the beginning of May, however, these differences over foreign policy were still muted, even between the FDR and Masyumi. The PNI, Masyumi, and FDR were all increasingly wary of the Dutch but continued grudgingly to feel that negotiations based on Renville should continue, and all supported widening the Republic’s relations with any country willing to offer diplomatic recognition. While the FDR wanted the stress to be on relations with Communist countries, it seemed to have no objection to relations with the West as well. For its part, the Masyumi seemed willing for relations to be estab lished with anyone, the Soviets not excluded.67 The Cold War was still a distant blur on the horizon: it would soon arrive. H atta—The C onsolidation o f P olitical Control
In early February, there had been doubts expressed over H atta’s ability to control the situation in the face of widespread FDR opposition and seemingly insurmountable eco nomic and military problems. By May, despite FDR efforts to the contrary, Hatta, who was noted even by his enemies as a “strong man,” was well in control.68 He had acted quickly and firmly to end disruptive demonstrations by the FDR, and, while his ban on demonstrations had been protested by the FDR,69 they had complied. On February 16, Hatta set forth a program of “rationalization” calling for widescale cutbacks in the armed forces. The government moved first against independent lasykar units, such as Bung Tomo’s BPRI and scattered guerrilla and bandit gangs in the Yogyakarta, Solo, and Wonosobo areas.70 Isolated from sources of outside support, these groups were dealt with effectively by government forces, with only the BPRI putting up any significant resistance (in late March).71 By March, the government had also started to implement rationaliza tion in those units of the TNI under its control, which included some 35,000 troops just evacuated from West Java. By May, 800 TNI officers had been put on reserve and some 50,000 soldiers returned to civilian work.72* To this point, however, only the easier ques tions of the army rationalization program had been tackled, and traditionally recalcitrant forces such as Solo’s Fourth Division had not yet been severely pressured. On the domestic scene, the economic picture was bleak and growing bleaker with the continuation of the strict Dutch blockade. The Republic issued angry protest after protest to the UN on the blockade, but no action was taken against the Dutch. Only one bright spot appeared on the domestic horizon and this was the H atta government’s attempts to deal with the complicated question of the rights of peasants versus those holding “conver sion rights” in areas planted in export crops. These lands were usually held by Indonesian
67 Siasat, May 23,1948, p. 12. In a mass meeting on May 16, the Masyumi and FDR issued a demand for the Republic to continue its foreign relations abroad. This was a standard demand and the Masyumi had not yet been faced with making a decision on relations with the USSR. 68 Manai Sofian, “Surat dari Jokja,” M erdeka, April 13,1948, p. 2. 69 FBIS, February 25,1948, quoting Batavia radio, February 21,1948. 70 Berita Indonesia, April 22,1948, p. 2; M erdeka, April 22,1948, p. 3. 71 M erdeka, April 12,1948, p. 2, April 8,1948, p. 1; Berita Indonesia, April 2,1948, p. 3, April 3,1948, p. 2. 12 FBIS, May 5,1948, quoting A ntara from Yogyakarta, May 4,1948; ibid., May 27,1948, quoting Voice o f Free Indonesia from Yogyakarta, May 25,1948.
31 princely families or under concession to Dutch or other foreigners. The problem centered on how to give the villagers control over their lands and abolish the “conversion rights” that most agreed constituted a feudalistic system of agriculture, without at the same time diminishing the supplies of export crops needed to shore up the Republic’s povertystricken budget and without prejudicing, in contradiction of Renville, the rights of foreign investors. FDR members, particularly the PKI, were calling for complete abolition of the “conversion rights” and some system of redistribution of land to landless peasants, while the more conservative Masyumi wanted to protect the rights of their land-holding mem bers. On April 24, the government was successful in passing a compromise law, which, while not as liberal as the FDR would have liked as it had no effect on the landless peas ants, seems to have been a step in the direction of easing the farmers’ problems in this one area. The original enthusiasm for the law quickly paled, but at first the government’s ef forts engendered quite a bit of support.73 In spite of the vociferous FDR campaign against the Masyumi, efforts continued to reach a compromise solution for a new cabinet. H atta’s success both in controlling FDR opposition and in taking the first steps toward rationalization of the armed forces, how ever, put him in a strong bargaining position. Sukarno seems to have been the leading force in the effort to find a compromise solution. In his speeches as he toured the country side, the President constantly urged the need for national unity and exercised his influence to moderate the positions of both left and right.74 The culmination of this effort came on May 20, National Reawakening Day, when all parties put out a joint statement agreeing on the need for national unity.75 This was accompanied by much speculation in the press that agreement was near on a new cabinet to include the FDR. The FDR was apparently ready to submerge its differences with the Masyumi for a place in the cabinet, and even the Masyumi was willing to work with the FDR.76 Apparently, far from having decided that it was impossible to work with the national bourgeoisie, Amir in mid-May was ready to play the politician’s game of compromise to win his party a place in the governing of the na tional revolution.
73 For a full discussion o f this question, see Sutter, Indonesianisasi, pp. 636-47. On March 31, 1948, the Yogyakarta branch of the BTI held demonstrations to praise the government declaration that “conversion lands” should be abolished in Yogyakarta and Solo (Berita Indonesia, April 1, 1948, p. 2). The BTI was, of course, PSI controlled, but in the early stages all sectors seemed hopeful that real progress could be made. The law as passed, however, made no provision for land to the landless as demanded by the FDR, and the benefit from the law went to those already holding land in the villages. A lso, the effect of the law was delayed so that the government could gain income from that year’s harvest. 74 In a speech on May 20,1948, in Yogyakarta, Sukarno criticized both the left (for wanting to have social revo lution before the national revolution) and the PNI (for being too national and ignoring the “international revolution”). Sukarno went on to appeal to the people not to be split by “class struggle” (Berita Indonesia, May 22,1948, p. 2). 75 A full discussion o f Sukarno’s efforts and the resulting joint statement is found in a P olice Report o f August 20,1948, put out in Yogyakarta covering May-July 1948, in a private Indonesian collection. A lso see Berita In donesia, May 22,1948. 76FBIS, June 1,1948, quoting Voice o f Free Indonesia from Yogyakarta, May 31,1948; Berita Indonesia, June 1, 1948, p. 1.
32
H aji Agus Salim
Suripno
A m ir Sjarijuddin
C hapter III T he O pposition M ounts
In mid-May 1948, it seemed possible that the widening breach between the FDR and the H atta government might be bridged before it became too serious. Events of late May were to shatter these hopes, and in the two months that followed the rift widened rather than narrowed. Increased FDR opposition during June and July, however, had little de monstrable effect, and by August, frustrated in its ambitions to regain a place in the Republic’s government, the FDR was ready to accept the new ideas and leadership which were soon to be offered. R ussia Com es to Indonesia: The Suripno A ffair
On May 26, a Russian announcement shattered hopes for achieving political unity in Indonesia and set the FDR on a course more in harmony with the Soviet Union’s twocamp line: Not long ago a special representative of the Republic of Indonesia, Minister Plenipotentiary Suripno, delivered a communication in the name of the government of the Republic of Indonesia to the Soviet Gov ernment through the embassy of the USSR in Prague relating to the es tablishment of relations between the Soviet Union and the Republic of Indonesia. As a result of discussions in Prague between both governments, an agreement was reached to establish consular relations and a reciprocal exchange of consuls between the USSR and the Republic of Indonesia. The agreement reached was confirmed by an exchange of letters be tween the Ambassador Plenipotentiary and Extraordinary, M. A. Silin, and the special Envoy Extraordinary and Plenipotentiary Minister of the Republic of Indonesia, Dr. Suripno. Both letters were dated May 22 at the Soviet Embassy in Prague.1* Almost since its inception, the Indonesian Republic had been engaged in an energetic search for relations with any nation willing to accord the Republic recognition. The prize
1 Pravda, May 26,1948, p. 2. Translation by Antony Diller. The word “confirmed” (par. 3) of the text has been translated as “ratification” in McVey, Soviet View, p. 49. However, the word “Zakreplenie” in most Rus sian dictionaries appears as “to confirm” or “to strengthen” with no alternate meaning of ratification. The word for ratification is usually given as “utverzhdenie” or “ratifikatsiia.”
33
34 sought was part of the game of “diplomasi,” the recognition by other sovereign nations of the Indonesian Republic’s claim to sovereignty in Indonesia. The Republic’s efforts, of course, infuriated the legal-minded Dutch, who, since they claimed sole sovereignty in all of Indonesia including that part occupied by the Republic, did everything in their power to block the Republic from gaining international recognition. Relations between the Indone sians and the Russians were anathema to the Dutch, and they were violent in their denun ciations of the agreement. In the chaos that ensued after the Russian announcement, fact and fancy became hopelessly intertwined and it is still difficult to reconstruct a clear pic ture of the events leading to the signing of the agreement. In June 1947, Suripno, an Indonesian youth leader, was sent by Sjahrir to Czechoslova kia to attend an international youth conference in Prague. At the same time, Suripno was authorized by Indonesian Foreign Minister Haji Agus Salim to set up an Information Center in Prague after the youth conference ended.2 Although not well known in Indone sia, Suripno was a brilliant young aristocrat who had spent the war years studying in Hol land and fighting with the Dutch Communist underground as one of Setiadjit’s recruits to the Dutch Communist Party. On his return to Indonesia in 1946, he continued his interest in international youth activities, participating in Indonesian delegations to various youth conferences.3 At some point in the fall of 1947, Suripno established contact with the Russian ambas sador to Prague, Silin, and then requested formal written permission from the Republic to negotiate agreements.4 On December 25 of that year, Sukarno and Acting Foreign Minis ter Tamzil authorized Suripno “to negotiate and sign agreements to establish friendly re lations with the governments of East and Central Europe and the USSR.”5 After the agreements were concluded and signed, the authorization stated they should then be re turned to “the President and Republic of Indonesia for ratification.”6 Suripno claimed to have received his letter of authorization on January 13,1948, and set about negotiations with the Russians which culminated in the signature of the agreement on May 2 2 ,1948.7*
2 Berita Indonesia, May 28,1948, p. 2, quoting an interview with Haji Agus Salim. A lso see Kahin, N ationalism , p. 268. A s the Republic in 1947 was seeking the broadest possible relations with all countries, it is quite pos sible that Suripno was also informally told to see what the possibilities were for developing better relations with Eastern Europe and the USSR. Indeed, Berita Indonesia (June 2,1948, p. 2) says that Suripno, like other officials abroad, had received instructions to strengthen relations and to seek aid from foreign governments in face o f the increased Dutch threat. 3 M erdeka, June 30,1948, p. 1, for a biography of Suripno. A lso see Sedjarah Perdjuangan Pem uda Indonesia (Jakarta: n.p., 1965), p. 179 and Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” pp. 24-25, p. 91. 4 Berita Indonesia, August 14,1948, p. 2, for Suripno interview. 5 Ibid., June 8,1948, p. 1. The full text o f Suripno’s authorization in English was released by the Republic. It is probably safe to assume that Suripno requested this written authority at the insistence of the Russians who may have been suspicious o f the young (27 years) delegate’s credentials, even though he was a Communist. The Republic stressed in its communique on Suripno (May 29,1948), that the authorization was sent before the Renville Agreements were signed (Berita Indonesia, May 31, 1948, p. 1). The implication was that the Republic could not be charged with actively seeking foreign relations after Renville. 6 Ibid. 7 Ibid., August 14, 1948, p. 1, from an interview with Suripno. A lso see McVey, Soviet View, p. 49, quoting Suripno statement on Radio Jogjakarta (August 13, 1948), that he had opened the negotiations on receipt o f his authorization, but that “owing to unforeseen circumstances the agreement could not be signed until May 22.” Lt. Governor General van Mook gives a different explanation for these circumstances, saying that Suripno had been trying for agreement before May 22, but he was “consistently staved off by the Russian Embassy until it suddenly accepted the proposal shortly before that date.” (H. J. van Mook, The Stakes o f
35 There is some controversy over whether or not the H atta government was fully aware of Suripno’s negotiations with the Russians,8 and it is evident in any case that the rapid conclusion of those negotiations caught the Indonesians completely by surprise. On May 27, Foreign Minister Salim denied that the Republic had ever authorized Suripno to nego tiate with the Russians.9 On May 29, however, while still denying any personal knowledge of Suripno’s mission, Salim admitted the Sukarno authorization had been sent, but pointed out caustically that it was very odd Suripno had not informed his government be fore signing such an important agreement.10 It seems hardly likely the H atta government could have been completely unaware of Suripno’s mission.11* However, it is possible that, having heard little or nothing from Suripno since December 1947, the government had
Dem ocracy in Southeast A sia [New York: Norton, 1950], p. 286). Van Mook here is presumably drawing his information from confidential Dutch or US sources. There is no mention of “ratification” in any o f Suripno’s early statements when he first arrived back in Indonesia. However, he probably found himself under heavy criticism for signing the agreement without checking back with the Republic first. In the normal course o f events an agreement would be negotiated and signed by a properly authorized person (like Suripno) and then sent back to the country for “ratification,” i.e., for the country’s legislature or other body to enact the agreement into law. Agreements o f this type will not come into effect until they are ratified. Suripno (Kahin, “Memorandum o f Conversation,” September 6 and 7,1948) told George Kahin that he concluded and initialed an agreement with the Russians before the fall o f the Amir government on January 23, and then requested further instructions. A s he received no reply, Suripno said he assumed that Amir had been unable to finalize the agreement for fear of jeopardizing the newly negotiated Renville Agreements and that Hatta, when he came to office, “did not wish to undertake any more initiatives relative to the treaty.” On May 22, Suripno said, the USSR informed him that they had “ratified” the agreement, but Suripno then found he was unable to get ratification from the Hatta government. It is unlikely Suripno’s ratification tale is true as there is little indication of the agreements having been signed in Prague before May 22. 8 Foreign Minister Salim was out o f the country when Suripno’s authorization was sent. Deputy Foreign Min ister Tamzil was in Jakarta and, according to Salim, the foreign affairs portfolio was being held in Yogyakarta by Amir Sjarifuddin who was working out o f his Secretariat rather than out o f the Foreign Ministry. (Benia In donesia, May 28,1948, p. 2.) The papers on Suripno’s appointment seem to have stayed in Amir’s office, and thus Salim at least said he had no knowledge o f this authorization. While it is possible that Suripno’s authori zation was purposely kept from Hatta and Salim by Amir and Tamzil (a FD R member), with the complicity o f Sukarno, for fear that Hatta would object, this hardly seems likely. Secrets o f this type were hard to hold, es pecially with Sukarno involved, and Tamzil was apparently a cousin o f Sjahrir and a nephew o f Salim (conver sation with Professor B. R. O’G. Anderson) although he remained in the Partai Sosialis after the PSI split. If Suripno had already been given a broad oral authority to seek relations, however, it is quite possible that the written authorization was considered so “pro-forma” as not to be important. 9 Berita Indonesia, May 28,1948, p. 2. 10 Ibid., May 31, pp. 1-2. Salim was a former leader o f the Sarekat Islam and a strong anti-Communist (McVey, R ise o f Indonesian Communism, p. 297). An extremely sophisticated Moslem, he was not a member of the Masyumi because of a personal feud with its leader Sukiman. Known for his intelligence, wit, and shrewdness as the grand old man o f Indonesian politics, Salim was unlikely not to have been aware o f what was occurring in his own department. His protests to the press, although possibly a smoke screen to confuse critics while the government decided what to do, have a ring o f authenticity and it is possible he was unaware of Suripno’s written (as opposed to oral) authorization. 11 See note 8 above. The Indonesians had also been given som e forewarning that something was happening in Moscow, because on May 21, five days before the Russian announcement, the Dutch with their usual vocifer ousness had complained to the U N Good Offices Committee that they had a document proving the Republic was trying to establish relations with the Russians. (See P andji R n’ja t, June 1,1948, p. 1, for the Dutch com munique on the Suripno affair.) It is quite possible the Indonesians either did not believe the Dutch or felt that the Dutch were simply exaggerating Suripno’s presence in Prague. A lso see Taylor, Indonesian Independ ence, pp. 119-20.
36 assumed the talks were stalemated and that the Russians, like the United States, had no intention of extending the Republic formal recognition.12 Soviet motives in the Suripno affair will probably never be fully understood: Why did they delay the consular agreement so long and why did they choose May as the time for signing? Russian actions in the late forties were usually determined more by events in Europe than by those in East Asia, but, other than a general desire to create havoc for the West European imperialists in the “soft underbelly” of their colonies, little specific moti vation can be found. In April of 1948, the Marshall Plan had been signed into law in the US and, more importantly, on March 17,1948, the Netherlands had joined in the forerun ner of NATO in Europe, the European Western Union. By the beginning of April the Cold War had set in in earnest in Europe, and the Russians had begun to place the restric tions on traffic in and out of Berlin which were to culminate on June 23,1948, in the Berlin Blockade.13 Thus, any moves which might weaken one of the United States allies in Eu rope were certainly in line with current Soviet policy. The US State Department saw an other reason behind the Soviet move. In addition to speculating that the USSR was trying to disrupt the Renville Agreements, the Department in a cable to Batavia on May 28, 1948, stated “the USSR doubtless desired by this act to minimize offense to Muslim world resulting from USSR recognition Israel.”14 Soviet intentions toward the Hatta government are more difficult to ascertain. While the Soviets were at this time refraining from attacks on it, they had shown by their denun ciations of the “extreme rightist pro-American” Hatta cabinet when it was first formed without the Sayap Kiri, that they were well aware of the government’s conservative bias, and Soviet propaganda agencies had dropped Indonesia from their list of leaders of the Asian revolution after February.15 Soviet impressions of the Hatta government must have also been confirmed by reports from Tass correspondent Afrin who visited the Republic in March.16 However, the USSR had held off from attacks on the government since early February,17 perhaps feeling that in Russia’s Euro-centric view, the Republic’s anti-Dutch role was sufficient to merit support, whether or not it was led by a conservative govern ment. By May, however, the Russians were at the height of their dispute with Tito which was to culminate in Tito’s expulsion from the Cominform in late July,18and the Soviet line toward nationalism was beginning to harden.19 Ruth McVey has speculated that Russian motives in going ahead with the Indonesian consular agreement may have been both “to
12 It is interesting to speculate what the reaction of the Republic might have been to US recognition. The Dutch, however, kept a close watch on American dealings with the Republic to make sure that its ally did not slip into “de jure” recognition of the Republic. (See FRU S1 9 4 7 vol. 6, pp. 912-16 for a 1947 quarrel over the US even extending formal de facto recognition to the Republic.) 13 D . F. Fleming, The C old War an d its Origins, vol. 1 (Garden City, NY: Doubleday, 1961), pp. 489-500. 14 FRUS 1948, vol. 6, The Far East and Australia (Washington: US Government Printing Office, 1974), p. 190. Israel became independent on May 14,1948, and was recognized by the Soviet Union on May 18,1978. Golda Meir, My L ife (New York: Putnam, 1975), p. 231. 15 McVey, Soviet View, pp. 38-39,47. 16 Brackman, Indonesian Communism,, p. 72, for Afrin’s view of the Hatta government as “counterrevolution.” 17 McVey, Soviet View, p. 47. 18 Fleming, C old War, pp. 510-13; and Adam B. Ulam, Expansion and Coexistence (New York: Praeger, 1968), p. 468. 19 McVey, Soviet View, pp. 51-53.
37 serve as a counter weight to that country’s [Indonesian] dependence on American good will” and to “strengthen the Soviet claim to be the true defender of the Indonesian cause.”20 McVey continues that it is also possible that the Soviets had decided it was time to “call a showdown with the Republic and demand that the Indonesians declare them selves as allies of the Russian camp.”21 The Russians were probably also aware the agree ment would be an embarrassment to the conservative H atta government, and that Russian willingness to become the first major power to give “de jure” recognition to the Republic would give a boost to Indonesia’s left wing. The immediate effect of the Russian announcement was to put the H atta government in an extremely embarrassing position and to raise for the first time outside internal leftwing politics the question of Cold War allegiances. The Dutch, of course, immediately denounced the agreement and issued a series of “ultimatums” requiring the Republic to repudiate it.22 The Republic, however, had been adamant in its adherence to the principle that it was free to continue its foreign relations until the political negotiations for the Republic’s inclusion in the “United States of Indonesia” as provided by Renville were completed.23 The Republic had informal relations with several countries and as recently as May 3 had been formally recognized by Yemen.24 The unexpected Russian announce ment faced the Hatta government with a dilemma: to turn down recognition would not only be to bow to strong Dutch pressure, but also to break one of the Republic’s most firmly held principles, the right to conduct foreign relations. On the other hand, the H atta government was well aware that one of the few checks on continued Dutch aggression was American pressure, and establishment of relations with the USSR at this point could well endanger the little leverage that the Republic could exercise with the Americans. While the United States at this point was more concerned with maintaining the Nether lands as a strong ally against the Communists in Europe than in helping the Indonesian Republic against the Dutch,25it did exercise a moderating influence on the Dutch. The US representative to the UN Good Offices Committee, Coert Dubois, weighed in heavily with Indonesian leaders against the agreement almost immediately.26 The US views probably
20 Ibid., p. 49. 21 Ibid. 22 Berita Indonesia, June 5,1948, p. 1. 23A neta, January 22,1948; and Berita Indonesia, May 8,1948, p. 1. 24 Kementerian Luar Negeri, Facta dan Dokumen2, 6, p. 2. The Republic had representatives to the United Nations at Lake Success, in New Delhi, Karachi, Cairo, London, New York, and Singapore. India and Nation alist China both had representatives in Yogyakarta (Berita Indonesia, May 28,1948, p. 2). Moersahid Wongsodirdjo in his article on the Foreign Ministry in Darius Marpaung, Bingfdsan N asional (Jakarta: Usaha Pegawai Nasional Indonesia, 1955), p. 229, adds Bangkok, Rangoon, Canberra, Prague, and Manila to Berita Indonesia's list o f places where the Republic had “Kantor Perwakilan” (representative offices). Moersahid stresses, how ever, that these offices did not have diplomatic or consular status. 25 Taylor, Indonesian Independence, p. 398. Taylor says US policy favored the Dutch from August 1947 to December 1948; also see Roth, “American Flip Flop,” pp. 39-40. 26 The State Department’s reaction to the May 26 Russian announcement was very quick. On May 28, it cabled the US Consul General at Batavia, Livengood, that “Soviet announcement agreement exchange consu lar reps between USSR and Indo Repub occasions Dept great concern.” (FRUS 1948, vol. 6, p. 191.) The cable goes on to ask Livengood and Dubois whether they thought they should “catechize” the Republicans because the Department felt that the move to establish USSR-Republic relations was a sign of Indonesian in sincerity in carrying out the Renville Agreements (ibid., p. 192). Dubois, however, had already (on May 28) talked with Indonesian representatives to the GOC, Roem and Pringgodigdo, and had pointed out that “in
38 carried a great deal of weight with the Hatta government, which, unlike the FDR (see below), had not yet lost faith in the possibility of using US support to gain the Republic’s independence. The initial Indonesian reaction to the Soviet announcement was both startled and con fused. Salim on the 27th, while stating that the Republic had no intention of widening its foreign relations at the moment, added that if Russia wanted to recognize Indonesia uni laterally without any strings attached that would be acceptable.27 The government’s reluc tance to open relations with the Soviets, however, became more apparent on May 29. While continuing to insist on its right to conduct foreign relations, it announced on that date that it was recalling Suripno for “further consultations” on the agreements, and stated that the Republic at present had no intention of extending its foreign relations while the Renville negotiations were under way.28 This compromise solution, which amounted to stalling for time (neither refusing nor accepting the Russians’ offer), was an obvious solution to a difficult dilemma. Whether the Hatta cabinet took the decision solely be cause of US and Dutch pressure, as the Russians were to charge on June 8, is difficult to say.29 The Dutch were certainly violently opposing the agreement and the US had made its opposition clear. H atta’s own inclination, probably based on a desire to avoid further disruption of the Renville talks, seems to have been to oppose the agreement,30 and the Masyumi too may have been opposed.31 By July, Foreign Minister Salim was to tell an American reporter that he “was completely opposed to the agreement” which he feared would bring “dozens of Soviet correspondents into the Republic,”32 but it is unclear if this was his opinion in May. The FDR, however, favored immediate recognition33and appears to have been not only angered but also surprised by H atta’s decision to pass up what the FDR considered a golden opportunity to increase the Republic’s leverage against the Dutch at the conferabsence clear-cut answer from Republic making plain it had not sought recognition by USSR, position US D el [i.e. Dubois] would be seriously weakened respect its ability get sympathetic hearing by Dutch and State Dept o f Republic’s case in political negotiations” (ibid., p. 194). Pringgodigdo called on Dubois the next morning (May 29) to give him the Republic’s position on the USSR agreement which had been formulated at a cabinet meeting the evening of May 28. Pringgodigdo said that Hatta had never heard of Suripno’s orders which had been made by Amir (the cable leaves unclear if Hatta knew of the overall approach); that the cabinet was about to issue a press release that Suripno was to be recalled; and (most importantly) that “Hatta wishes us [Dubois] inform State Department that as long as he Prime Minister, there would be no exchange o f consuls with USSR” (ibid., p. 195). Hatta repeated this assurance to Dubois personally June 2 (ibid., p. 208). It should be noted that, while the State Department was plainly concerned with the extension of USSR influence into Indonesia, the cables between Batavia and Washington concentrate on Washington’s concern that the Repub lic was reneging on the spirit of the Renville Agreements that the Republic should not establish more relations with foreign governments in the interim period before the “United States o f Indonesia” was formed (ibid., pp. 191-209). 27 Berita Indonesia, May 28,1948, p. 2. 28 Ibid., May 31,1948, p. 1. 29 M erdeka, June 9, 1948, p. 1, quoting Pravda of June 8. Pravda continued to refrain from criticizing Hatta, but attacked the US and the Dutch for “using threats” against the Republic to keep it from entering “forbid den relations.” 30 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 8, says that Hatta’s attitude to the agreement was very negative. 31 The Masyumi, however, made no public statement on the issue. See note 36 below. 32 Christian Science Monitor, July 23,1948, p. 7. 33 Berita Indonesia, June 2, 1948, p. 1. Amir announced (probably on June 1) the FD R ’s opposition to Suripno’s recall. A lso see Derita, Lim a Minggu, p. 8.
39 ence table. Fears of American reactions had little impact on the FDR, as by this time FDR leaders, in particular Amir, were becoming increasingly disillusioned by what they considered a pro-Dutch US stance. In agreeing to Renville, Amir had counted on strong US support to assure that the agreements were enforced. Dutch creation of new puppet “states” in Dutch-held territory had brought little US reaction, and by May Amir was becoming convinced that his trust in Washington was being betrayed.34 He was to point this out clearly later in July when he questioned what possible aid the Republic felt it could get from the US, which was plainly pro-Dutch.35 Strident FDR opposition to H atta’s decision to recall Suripno brought to a standstill for the next few weeks the nearly concluded negotiations to form a coalition government. The PNI and Masyumi both seem to have supported the government on Suripno’s recall36 and, as FDR opposition was vehement, it was plain that no agreement could be forthcoming until tempers cooled. However, while the FDR over the next few months was to use the recognition issue very successfully to stir up nationalist opposition against the H atta gov ernment, it also continued through mid-August to follow a nationalist rather than a Sovietoriented foreign policy line, as it did not call for relations only with the Soviet bloc or for a stop to negotiations with the Dutch. The FDR campaign for acceptance of the Suripno agreement did, however, put the Cold War question squarely in the middle of Indonesian politics. The FDR became increasingly associated with the Soviet Union both in its own statements and in the minds of its opponents. On the other hand, the H atta government appeared to the left to be pro-US because of its obvious reluctance to recognize the USSR, and seemed soft toward the Dutch because of its continued willingness to seek compromise solutions. The Dutch Threat: Backdrop to the P olitical Scene
In the weeks immediately following the Suripno affair, tensions between the Dutch and Indonesians soared to heights they had not reached since just prior to the beginning of the first Dutch “police action” a little less than one year earlier, and many observers felt Indo nesia was on the brink of more open warfare. The Dutch, who tended to be very sensitive on the subject of communism in Indonesia, chose to use the possibility that the Republic might open contact with the Soviet Union as an excuse for loud ultimata and saber rat tling. On June 1, the Dutch representative to the Renville political talks, van Vredenburch, announced that the Republic’s decision to call Suripno home did not satisfy the Dutch demand that the Republic denounce the Suripno agreements. Because of this, van Vredenburch continued, he was leaving the talks for Jakarta on June 2, and would discuss with the Netherlands government what further steps should be taken.37 34 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 274. 35 M erdeka, July 26,1948, p. 1. 36 Neither the Masyumi nor the PNI issued statements on Suripno’s recall, but, as both were in the govern ment, it seem s fair to assume that they supported Hatta’s decision. The Police Report, August 20,1948, p. 16, says that Masyumi’s attitude was “Tunggu dulu” (wait a while), i.e., much like Hatta’s, and that the PNI posi tion, as usual, was unclear. Over the next weeks, the FD R campaign for recognition of Russia pushed the gov ernment, which was thought by the FDR to be bending to Dutch pressure, onto the defensive. No Republi cans could openly oppose relations with Russia as this would seem against Indonesia’s neutral role and her desire for foreign relations. 37 PandjiRa*jat, June 1,1948, p. 1. The Dutch actions in this case may have been influenced by domestic poli tics in the Netherlands. Elections were scheduled for the beginning of July, and the Communist issue may have been used by the Dutch government in an attempt to gamer right-wing votes at home.
40 Previous Dutch ultimata had ended in “police actions,” and the Republic therefore girded itself for battle. Assuming that the negotiations were about to be halted, H atta is sued a warning that the Republic was ready to fight for years if necessary, and General Sudirman called for a general mobilization of troops to meet the Dutch threat. Sudirman also warned that the TNI was ready to take the helm itself if excessive concessions were made by the civilian government to Dutch demands for a dissolution of the TNI.38 While tempers cooled somewhat in the next few weeks, tensions remained high. In a desperate attempt to get negotiations under way again, the US and Australian representatives to the GOC, Dubois and Critchley, on June 10 put forward a compromise proposal calling for a general plebiscite to determine Indonesia’s future. The proposal was accepted by the Republic but rejected by the Dutch, who were infuriated by the American representative, Dubois, who had exceeded his instructions in putting forward the plan.39 By July 1, ten sions were up again as Merdeka carried a Dutch report that the Dutch were preparing a new police action, and by July 23 the Indonesians themselves called a halt to the political talks with the Dutch on the basis of the Dutch refusal to accept the Critchley-Dubois pro posal. Thus at the beginning of August, while economic talks were continuing with the Dutch, a total impasse had been reached on the sensitive political side, and relations be tween the Dutch and the Indonesians were on the razor’s edge. It is against this background of continual crisis in Dutch-Indonesian relations that the drama of heightened FDR opposition to the government was played in June, July, and early August. FDR opposition, however, continued to center more on domestic issues than on the question of negotiations with the Dutch. The FDR denounced H atta’s deci sion to recall Suripno and was probably able to make good use of the Soviet statement that Suripno’s recall was another example of the Americans and Dutch not allowing the Re public to have relations with “dangerous states.”40 Amir came out firmly against the Critchley-Dubois compromise as weakening the Renville Agreements and called for the whole question of Indonesia to be returned to the UN Security Council.41 When the politi cal talks finally broke down on July 23 Amir loudly approved, berating the Dutch for their bad faith and calling for an end to meetings on other (i.e., social and economic) matters. (Amir was joined here by Sjahrir who thought the political talks should have been broken off in June.42) However, while by the beginning of August most Indonesians were very discouraged over the prospects of the talks with the Dutch and momentarily expecting a Dutch attack, even Amir still held to the false hope that “Renville” could be used as a basis for talks with the Dutch, if only the Dutch would show good faith. The Changing Tactics o f the FDR By early June, the disagreement over the Suripno agreement had forced the FDR back into opposition. H atta’s decision to recall Suripno seems to have genuinely surprised the 38 Keng Po, June 3, June 4, June 5,1948; and Berita Indonesia, June 5,1948, p. 1. A lso see FBIS, June 4,1948, quoting Netherlands government radio Hilversum broadcasting to Indonesia (June 3, 1948), that Hatta had threatened to fight for years if there was a new “police action.” Hilversum commented that the breaking off of the talks being threatened by the Dutch did not necessarily cancel the truce. 39 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 249; Taylor, Indonesian Independence, pp. 125,406; F R U S1948, vol. 6, pp. 231-66. 40 Berita Indonesia, June 9,1948, p. 1. 41 K engP o, June 22,1948, p. 1; M erdeka, June 23,1948, p. 2. 42 Keng Po, July 26,1948, p. 1; Kementerian Luar Negeri, Fakta dan Dokumen2, vol. 3, pt. 6, p. 60.
41 FDR, and they began to regard the Hatta government in a far more conservative and unpalatable light.43 To date, FDR had had little success in its efforts to topple the govern ment, which indeed appeared to be growing more confident of its ability to rule without the left wing. In view of this, the FDR seems to have decided in late May and early June that stronger methods were needed. The FDR’s heightened campaign against the government took place on several levels: primarily, it involved continued attacks against the Masyumi, augmented now by agitation for relations with the USSR and for a stronger stance against the Dutch who were becom ing increasingly threatening. The FDR’s propaganda campaign was aimed at utilizing sources of discontent and winning support from any possible sectors of the Republic: from the young men who were impatient to fight the Dutch; from the soldiers who were dis couraged and concerned over the rationalization program; from the peasantry whose lot had always been difficult in overpopulated Central Java; and finally from the “workers,”44 the principal target of Amir’s left wing, who had been hard hit, especially in the cities, by the Dutch economic blockade and by problems of government corruption which had plagued the Republic since its inception. 1. L a b o r The Delanggu Strikes
The FDR tactics, however, went beyond simple speechmaking. In June, a new method for undermining the cabinet’s authority and gaining public support was brought into play: the strike. Workers on the government-controlled complex of cotton plantations and tex tile mills in the Delanggu area outside Solo had long been discontent with the government’s management of the area. The BTN (Badan Textil Negara, State Textile Board) was reportedly involved in all manner of corrupt dealings with private merchants (both Chinese and Indonesian) at the expense of the laborers. Although the troubles had been going on for some time, the SARBUPRI or Plantation Workers’ Union, under PKI leader M aruto Darusman, had held off from attacking the BTN while Amir’s government was still in control. Dining May 1948, however, problems between the workers and the BTN came to a head, and on May 19, thousands of factory workers and cotton growers from the Klaten area outside Solo demonstrated before BTN headquarters in Solo for back pay and allotments of cloth due them since 1947. W hether or not at this early stage the disturbances were “politically motivated” is hard to judge, as the demands went back well before the Hatta government’s formation.45 Lo cal strikes at several of the plantations began on May 26, but by June 1, the issue was start ing to involve SOBSI organizations other than the purely local ones. By June 19, negotia tions between the local unions and the BTN had broken down and the head office of SOBSI, represented by Maruto Darusman, took full control of the strike. Almost every one was later willing to admit that the Delanggu strikers had real grievances, but from the moment the conduct of the strike was taken over by SOBSI, the issue became a political football. The Masyumi minister of welfare, Sjafruddin Prawiranegara, quickly charged
43 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 7. 44 “Workers” in the Republic covered a broad spectrum o f government employees, pedicab drivers and other city dwellers, som e oil workers (Cepu), and plantation workers. The majority of Indonesia’s bonafide workers were in Dutch-held industrial areas in Jakarta, Surabaya, and Semarang. 45 Police Report, August 20,1948, p. 71.
42 that the strikes were solely political,46 and the government radio broadcast statements criticizing the strikers for weakening the national struggle against the Dutch.47 Pro-gov ernment forces, including on this occasion Tan Malaka’s Murba, pointed out that Amir, who once felt that strikes in a time of national emergency against the Dutch weakened the country and should be avoided, was now supporting the strike.48 SOBSI on the other hand, supported by the FDR, issued an inflammatory statement that the national struggle which it supported was anti-imperialist externally and anti-colonial and anti-feudal within the country.49 By early July, the issue of the strikes had reached crisis proportions. The FDR was circulating anti-government posters in Yogyakarta, sentiment evidently was swinging against the government, and the PKI/FDR newspaper Suara Ibu Kota, in an effort to bring down the cabinet, went so far as to float the rumor that Sukiman and Sjafruddin al ready had resigned.50 As the strikes at Delanggu accelerated into a national issue between the FDR and the government (primarily the Masyumi, for it was Masyumi ministers who were involved), the fight became re-reflected on the local level. By July 3, the press was carrying reports that if the strike was not settled soon, “aliran” (i.e., PKI vs. Masyumi) trouble was going to break out between the SARBUPRI strikers and members of the smaller Islamic peasants’ union, the STII (Sarekat Tani Islam Indonesia, Indonesian Islamic Farmers’ Associa tion).51 The STII was controlled by the Masyumi and, apparently on orders from Masyumi headquarters, was attempting to break the strike and harvest the cotton fields.52 Both Pesindo and Hizbullah armed units were moved into the area by the FDR and Masyumi to protect their respective workers, and PKI/SARBUPRI leader Darusman as well as Labor Party (PBI) leader Setiadjit were on the scene directing the FDR workers.53 The issue came to a head on July 9,10, and 13 when small armed clashes took place between STII strikebreakers and their Hizbullah guards, who had taken control of some areas, and demonstrating SARBUPRI members, guarded by armed Pesindo units.54* Several people were injured on both sides, and the strike threatened to flare into a general conflagration. At this point, Hatta took immediate action to avoid more clashes between the strikers and the Islamic groups and to calm the situation which was threatening to rock his cabi net. Hizbullah units were ordered to leave the area and General Sudirman sent in TNI units (Siliwangi under Colonel Sentot Iskandardinata) to bring the situation under con-
46 Berita Indonesia, June 26,1948, p. 1. 47 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 266. 48 Berita Indonesia, July 1, pp. 1-2. 49 Ibid., July 1,1948, p. 1, July 3,1948, p. 2. 50 Police Report, August 20,1948, p. 15; Berita Indonesia, July 15,1948, p. 2. 51 Berita Indonesia, July 3,1948, p. 2. 52 Ibid. 53 Ibid., July 4,1948, p. 2. Siliwangi dari M asa ke M asa (Jakarta: Fakta Mahjuma, 1968), p. 230, also gives an account of various forces on the ground. 54 Berita Indonesia, July 16, 1948, p. 2. A lso see Siliwangi, p. 230. The Hizbullah troops were probably only willing to withdraw because it was “friendly” Siliwangi troops which were sent in. It was normal, however, for the government to use this “reserve unit” to calm strikes. Hizbullah seems to have had many more troops on hand than Pesindo, for they were actually able to take over some areas of Delanggu and hold them under a quasi-military government (see Berita Indonesia, July 16,1948).
43 trol.55 At the same time, H atta met with SOBSI leaders on July 14 and made what were apparently reasonable concessions to their demands which by July 17 had brought the strikes to a close.56 During the Delanggu strikes, the FDR had shown its strength and had won a great deal of sympathy for its cause among workers in other Indonesian towns. In the middle of the strike, pro-government forces in the working committee of the KNIP had narrowly de feated an FDR proposal for ending the strikes, but the FDR was able to win in the field what it had lost in Parliament, and the settlement of July 17 forced the government to make major concessions.57 On the other hand, the FDR had not succeeded in its primary goal of forcing a crisis large enough to bring down the Hatta government, and, if anything, Hatta emerged from Delanggu stronger and more certain of his power. Even Sukarno had joined him in urging the workers to return to their jobs.58 The strike had also raised tensions between the FDR and Masyumi supporters in the Delanggu area to almost intol erable levels and had given a portent of the kind of hostilities lying just below the surface. The end of the Delanggu strikes only partially eased tensions. For at least a week after the strike’s end small wildcat strikes broke out in other parts of the Republic, forcing the gov ernment to state harshly that it might be forced to take further action.59 2. The Farmers
The FDR’s activities during this period were not confined solely to labor. It also at tempted to win more followers to its banner among the farmers by agitational methods. Because of its earlier emphasis on labor, the FDR had allowed the central organization of the BTI to remain under the control of the PSI, and, in its work, it was now somewhat limited either to those BTI local branches it controlled or to using other peasant organiza tions such as the PKI’s Sarekat Rakyat. Charging that the government was not moving quickly enough to implement the newly passed land reform laws, the FDR started to agi tate among farmers in areas around Solo, Madiun, and Purwodadi.60 While the FDR had earlier urged that concession land be given to the landless peasant, the land reform law passed in April 1948 made no provision for this. The FDR now changed its tack, and demanded that village-owned land (kas-desa) and land set aside for allowances for village officials (Jungguh) be redistributed among the poor peasants.61
55 Siäwangi, p. 230. 56 Berita Indonesia, July 17,1948, p. 1; and Police Report, August 20,1948, pp. 77-78. ^ Berita Indonesia, July 13,1948, p. 2; and Police Report, August 20,1948, p. 15. According to Berita Indonesia, the FD R proposal was defeated fifteen to thirteen while the government proposal was accepted fifteen to twenty. 58 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 266. 59 Berita Indonesia, July 28,1948, p. 1. 60 Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 4. Sjahrir was later to charge in Indonesian Socialism (p. 44) that the “com munists taught the struggle against the religious party, the Masjumi, was essentially the struggle against the landlords and usurers in the villages.” 61 Selosoemardjan, Social Changes in Jogjakarta (Ithaca: Cornell University Press, 1962), p. 178.
44 FDR agitation among the peasants resulted in disturbances and brought demands from the peasants that more “conversion lands” be seized and immediately returned to them.62 FDR agitation by mid-August had reached the point that the Masyumi minister of the in terior, Dr. Suleiman, in an effort to bring the FDR under control, issued a prohibition against groups agitating among the peasantry.63 This prohibition, of course, served only to infuriate the FDR, which charged with some validity that the Masyumi did not wish to implement land reform and was using its position in the government to block FDR ef forts.64 3 . The FDR and the Arm y
While both labor and the peasantry was needed to build the FDR’s mass support, nei ther was as important to the FDR as the army. FDR influence in the armed forces was crucial both to protect itself against attacks from other forces and for any offensive moves the FDR might wish to make. FDR efforts to win rank-and-file support in the TNI and lasykarunits were aided during June and July by increasing Dutch intransigence and by the discontent in the ranks arising from the implementation of H atta’s rationalization pro gram. Amir and the FDR continually attacked rationalization, claiming that the govern ment was not caring properly for those who were being demobilized.65 Amir also used the growing Dutch threat to point to the need for “total people’s defense,”66 or the arming of large groups of irregular troops who would then be ready to face the Dutch in scattered guerrilla warfare . . . and of course groups where FDR propaganda efforts could be more effective than in the TNI. Needless to say, the question of reducing the size of the armed forces at a time when the Republic seemed to be facing the another all-out Dutch attack was not popular in the army. H atta’s rationalization plan as formulated in his speech to Parliament on February 16 called for a staged reduction of Indonesia’s massive armed forces from an ill-armed and badly trained organization of approximately 800,000 regular and irregular troops to a tightly disciplined army of approximately 160,000 men backed up by militia units in the vil lages.67* From the beginning of the program, rumors circulated that rationalization was simply a ploy to dissolve the TNI as a concession to Dutch demands that a single (Dutch-controlled) army be formed for all Indonesia. On March 5, the TNI leadership, including
62 Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 54. 63 Hatta speech to the Working Committee of the KNIP, September 16, 1948, in Kementrian Luar Negeri, Fakta, vol. 7, p. 40. Replying to PKI criticisms on the government’s land-reform program, Hatta said that re forms must be carried out within the law. “What is forbidden by the order [Surat Kawat] o f the Minister of the Interior on August 14, 1948, are acts from groups which are irresponsible, who only intend to gain political profit by winning the hearts of the people who are given land___ ” 64 Suara Ibu Kota, September 17,1948, reported PKI complaints against the Masyumi on land reform. A lso see Suripno, “Tulisan,” p. 79. Suripno says his friends felt threatened by the government’s harassment on the local level, especially the “instruction of the Interior Minister to restrict us with an iron fist in the field o f agricul ture.” 65 Berita Indonesia, June 12,1948, p. 1; June 15,1948, p. 1. 66 Ibid., July 12 and July 15,1948. 67 Nasution, 77VJ, 2:130; and Kahin, N ationalism , p. 262. Kahin says that eventually it was hoped that the troop strength could be reduced to 57,000 troops.
45 Sudirman, produced a statement that the TNI would “refuse any plan which would violate the sovereignty of the TNI.”68 While the FDR played on these army fears in its efforts to gain support, suspicions regarding the H atta government were not just a creation of the left wing. Sudirman’s June 3 statement that the army would take control if it appeared that H atta was about to sell out the army to the Dutch is an indication of how seriously the TNI took this problem.69 As late as August 10, H atta was forced to issue a statement denying that any concessions would be made to the Dutch to dissolve the TNI.70 The rationalization program as drawn up by Sudirman and Nasution during February and March 1948 had two main parts:71 demobilization of the lasykar, including the disman tling of the FDR-controlled TNI Masyarakat apparatus; and the reorganization of the regular army. The dismantling of the TNI Masyarakat seems to have proceeded with ex treme ease and rapidity, probably because the organization had exercised little real influ ence over the units under its command, and had worked chiefly as a propaganda arm of the FDR in the lasykar and as a channel for funds to Sayap Kiri forces. Demobilization of the lasykar themselves and reorganization of the TNI, however, was another question, as here the government was face to face with armed groups often under the control of hostile political forces. As mentioned in Chapter II, the government first tackled Bung Tomo's BPRI and other scattered lasykar units which in reality were little more than local bandit groups. (Bung Tomo had “retired” from command of the BPRI in January, and his units evidently had got out of control.72) Other lasykar units, such as the Hizbullah and Pesindo, which were controlled by powerful political groupings had not been touched, nor were they to be disturbed in any effective manner until after the Madiun coup. The question of these lasykar is complicated by the fact that parts of their forces were incorporated in regular army units (the Hizbullah in the Siliwangi and Pesindo in Divisions IV and VI). As far as can be seen in the use made of these units by both sides for the Madiun fighting, by September little headway had been made in disarming lasykar troops controlled by either Masyumi or the FDR. Rationalization of the TNI itself proceeded no better than that of the large lasykar. By March 25,1948, Nasution had drawn up a plan for the reorganization of the existing seven TNI divisions on Java into three new divisions, one for West Central Java including Yogyakarta, one for East Central Java including Solo, one for East Java, and a “General Reserve Unit” composed of the Siliwangi Division centered in Solo.73 Rationalization
68 Nasution, TNI, 2 :15: “Menolak setiap rentjana jang hendak melanggar kedaulatan TNI.” 69 Berita Indonesia, June 5,1948, p. 1. Sudirman threatened that the TNI would take the helm itself (menegang kendali sendiri). 70 Ibid., August 10,1948. 71 According to Nasution, 77V/, 2:156, on March 8, Sudirman was formally appointed by Sukarno to set up a committee to carry out reorganization of the armed forces. The committee as constituted included Major General Susalit (representing ex-Peta and lasykar), Major General Suwardi (ex-KNIL) and Nasution (repre senting younger officers). On March 25, Nasution issued his plan for reorganization called “Instruksi Panglima Besar Tentang Rekonstruksi Kesatuan2 Mobil dan Territorial” (ibid., 166-67). “Baharuddin’s Plan” or the authorizing legislation for the reorganization was not signed into law by Sukarno after passage by the KNIP until May 5 (ibid., p. 151). 72 FBIS, January 23, 1948, discusses Bung Tom o’s retirement. A lso see M erdeka, April 13, 1948, p. 2 and Sedjarah Diponegoro, p. 170 on actions to control BPRI troops in Solo. 73 Nasution, 77V/, 2:166.
46 seems to have proceeded smoothly among troops from West and West Central Java who were loyal to the Hatta cabinet and to the new Sudirman-Nasution duumvirate in the armed forces, established in February.74 Nasution, as former commander, held the abso lute loyalty of the Siliwangi and the re-stationing of the division as a “General Reserve Unit” around Solo also seems to have gone smoothly. Troops from Gatot Subroto’s Divi sion II Sunan Gunung Djati and from Susalit’s Division III Diponegoro were also merged into the new Division I under Subroto’s old chief of staff, Bambang Sugeng. This new division was headquartered in Magelang (with Susalit commanding troops in Yogyakarta) and was to prove absolutely loyal to the government.75 Gatot Subroto, by training a police officer,76 in a satisfactory trade off was named the new commander of the Military Police (CPM—Corps Polisi Militer).77 The commander of Division V, Djatikusumo, also seems to have been willing to demobilize his division and take a position on the central command staff of the TNI.78 Sudirman and Nasution, however, had no success in Solo and East Java where they apparently attempted to install men loyal to them as military commanders, rather than simply retaining the popular local commanders, Sutarto (Division IV-Senopati) and Sungkono (Division VI).79 Sutarto, whose division was composed of a large percentage of FDR-controlled ALRI (Angkatan Laut Republik Indonesia, Republic of Indonesia Naval Forces) and Pesindo troops, simply stalled on his orders to demobilize some of his men and merge his command into the new Division II being formed for East Central Java.80 Sungkono, taking advantage of his isolated position in East Java, informed Sudirman that his commanders refused to merge their troops into the new East Java Command, Division III. (Sungkono’s refusal to merge, made at the last minute, caused Sudirman to cancel his trip to attend the installation ceremonies for the new commander, Bambang Supeno, and later forced Supeno to resign from the command he was never able to occupy.81) The re sistance of both Sutarto and Sungkono to the central command’s rationalization orders seems to have been due more to a desire to maintain their local autonomy and influence,
74 Ibid., pp. 145-46: Nasution was appointed second in command to Sudirman on February 27,1948. Sudirman was head o f the active units o f the Indonesian armed forces, i.e., Angkatan Perang Mobil. The choice seem s to have been between Nasution and Djatikusumo. 75 Susalit was half brother to Partai Sosialis (PS) member Abdulmadjid and this relationship may have occasioned Berita Indonesia’s comment on September 28,1948, that the FDR was counting on Yogya troop support. Susalit, however, at this point was close to Sudirman, and, if a rather eliptical remark of Nasution’s is to be believed, Sudirman hoped at one point to get Susalit as his deputy (TNI, 2:156). The Sudirman-Susalit relationship is cloudy, as in mid-1946 Sudirman had apparently blocked Susalit’s appointment as commander of Division III until forced to accept him by the younger officers of the division. (See Anderson, Java, pp. 405-
6.) 76 Subroto served in the KNIL from 1928 to 1942 but in 1934 he was given police training in Sukabumi. He was Daidancho in the Banyumas Peta during the war. 77 Nasution, TNI, 2: 214,177. When rationalization failed in Solo and East Java, Sudirman temporarily halted the efforts to combine the troops, probably to save face. The only result was that in West Central Java, Susalit was given back command o f the old Division III in Yogyakarta (ibid., pp. 185-86). 78 Sedjarah Diponogoro, p. 175, Djatikusumo was eventually named Chief of Staff o f the Army (KSAD). A lso see Kahin, N ationalism , p. 264. 79 Ibid., pp. 166,178,184,212; and Nasution, TNI, 1: 299. 80 Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 265-66. Kahin says that Division VI had only 5,000 men. 81 Nasution, TNI, 1:184.
47 and to save their troops from demobilization, than to motives directly tied to the F D R / Masyumi fight. Many of the units under Sutarto, like those under Sungkono, were considered FDRcontrolled (the ALRI-Jadau and Pesindo units), and as the TNI command moved to con solidate its control over the Solo Division IV the move was widely interpreted as an effort to weaken FDR influence in the armed forces. On the other hand, the army command could hardly allow its commanders to disobey orders, and the long-recalcitrant Sutarto82 was in the unfortunate position of being closer to the power center in Yogyakarta than the equally disobedient Sungkono. The government had also stationed its most obedient tool, the Siliwangi Division, in the Solo area, and this factor gave the government a new element of control which had hitherto been lacking. Sudirman’s efforts to bring Sutarto to heel, however, seem to have been more through the time-honored method of negotiation than through force. What would have been the result of these negotiations will never be known, as on July 2,1948, Sutarto was assassinated.83 Accusations and counter-accusations started to fly. Government supporters blamed the FDR for the assassination, saying that the front wished to cause trouble in Division IV by the assassination of its popular commander, and that the FDR also feared that Sutarto was about to give in to Sudirman’s command. The FDR, on the other hand, intimated that the Hatta government was behind the deed in an effort to control Division IV.84 Responsibility for Sutarto’s death probably never will be fixed, but the FDR’s followers in Division IV were undoubtedly convinced that the hand of the government was present there. Tensions in Solo soared, and the government with the Delanggu strike on its hands was in no position to take immediate action. Colonel Suadi, one of Sutarto’s closest lieu tenants and a Sudirman, rather than an FDR man, was allowed to replace Sutarto al though his views on rationalization seem to have been close to Sutarto’s. Suadi promptly took a large portion of his troops out on troop maneuvers through the Solo area, probably in an attempt to cool off the situation.85* By early August, sympathy for the FDR among the rank and file in Indonesia’s armed forces had probably if anything increased, especially in the Solo and East Java areas. However, when dealing with armies, control over commanders is usually much more im portant than control over the troops themselves. In the rationalization program, the FDR
82 Sutarto in 1946 had supported Dr. Muwardi, the Barisan Banteng, and Solo’s social revolutionary forces against attempts by Amir and Sjahrir to reestablish their control over Solo’s social revolution (Anderson, Java, ch. 15). Sutarto had also been sympathetic to the Tan Malaka followers who staged the July 3 Affair (Anderson, Java, ch. 16). On May 20, troops from Sutarto’s command, apparently with Sutarto’s blessing, had demonstrated against rationalization in Solo. This action was considered “machtsvertoning” or a show of force against the central government (see Sedjarah Diponegoro, p. 179). 83 M erdeka, July 5,1948, p. 2. 84 Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 42. Another explanation may be that Sutarto was killed by overenthusiastic members of Dr. Muwardi’s Barisan Banteng without specific orders from the government. Sutarto, however, may have also just turned down an FD R invitation to join forces with it. A lso see Sedjarah Diponegoro, p. 177, on Sutarto’s death. 85 Berita Indonesia, August 5, 1948, p. 1. Suadi spent the month chasing down bandits and unruly elements. His “maneuvers” may also have been a show of force to demonstrate he was really in control.
48 had lost the TNI Masyarakat command structure,86 although how important this was as an actual weapon is hard to calculate. More important, they had lost a possible recruit by the death of General Sutarto, and the position of their ALRI and Pesindo troops within Divi sion IV was now very exposed, even though Suadi continued, like Sutarto, to stall on ra tionalization. FDR forces in East Java under Sungkono seemed fairly safe, but Sungkono's loyalties were uncertain. More important yet, rationalization had given H atta’s central government a tighter control over the forces in West Central Java and Yogyakarta. The FDR seems to have had few firm supporters within the higher echelons of the army itself,87 and the army com mand structure, as reorganized in February, brought pro-government Nasution in as Sudirman’s deputy in the Angkatan Perang Mobil (Mobile Army), the actual fighting force of the TNI. While Sudirman was impatient with the government's “soft” stance against the Dutch, and more or less neutral in the FDR/Masyumi fight, he was also very ill during this period with the tuberculosis which was to cause his death in 1950. Thus, much of the rationalization program was in the hands of Nasution, a Moslem Sumatran, who, while attached to no political group, was a firm supporter of his fellow Sumatran, Hatta, and, like Hatta, was a no-nonsense administrator. While Nasution later in the 1950s was to start to promote the value of a “people's army,''88 at this point he was determined to consolidate the chaotic Indonesian fighting forces under central TNI command. Thus, at the beginning of August, the FDR's forces tended to be dispersed and disor ganized, while the government could now count on the support of its army's central com mand, of the well-trained and armed Siliwangi Division and, most importantly, of its forces in the capital city of Yogyakarta. The FDR was beginning to feel the pressure of rationali zation and many of its military commanders were starting to “run scared." Already the TNI Masyarakat had been dissolved, and some of the young officers such as the Pesindo commander, Sumarsono, saw Sutarto's assassination as a sign that the H atta government would stop at nothing to bring the left wing's armed forces under its control.89 The C oalition Government—A Fading Dream
As rationalization in the armed forces progressed, the FDR's suspicions of government intentions increased, and the FDR's strikes, agitation among the peasantry, and continual attacks against the government for its “soft” position in talks with the Dutch brought the front into daily and mounting conflict with more conservative forces. To combat FDR propaganda, the Masyumi, starting in mid-May, countered with rallies of its own and sent speakers touring the countryside to warn against what Kasman Singodimedjo, one of the Masyumi’s chief propagandists, was to call the FDR's “Sosialiseering Serampangan,” ef-
86 The FD R had two top generals in the TNI Masyarakat, Djokosujono and Sakirman, both o f whom lost their positions (Nasution, TNI, 2:155). Pepolit, the political propaganda bureau for the army was also dissolved at the same time. (Nasution, TNI, 2:127.) 87 According to an alleged FD R document shown to George Kahin after the coup, the FD R claimed control of only one slot in the TNI, the deputy commander for Java (Kahin, N ationalism , p. 269). 88 See A . H. Nasution, Towards a People's A rm y (Jakarta: Delegasi, 1964). Judged by Nasution’s general atti tude towards Sudirman in the second volume of TNI, relations between the two commanders may have been somewhat strained during this period. 89 P olice Report, August 20,1948, p. 50.
49 forts to stir up the peasants and labor by fake “random socialization.”90 Added to the Masyumi’s attacks from the right, the FDR was now under full-fledged attack from the left by the Tan Malaka forces, the GRR (Gerakan Revolusi Rakyat, People’s Revolutionary Movement), whose strength was being steadily augmented as some of the younger Tan Malaka leaders were released from prison.91 The GRR’s program was close to that of the FDR, except that it was even more radical, calling for immediate revocation of the Ren ville Agreements and a halt to talks with the Dutch.92 The GRR’s mounting campaign against the FDR during June and July naturally attracted some of the firebrand pemuda (youth) support which would otherwise have turned to the FDR. The drive to consensus politics, however, is a strong one in Indonesia, and efforts con tinued throughout even the most difficult periods in June and July to draft a compromise National Program which could serve as a basis for a new national government. As passed by the Parliament and accepted by the H atta cabinet on July 27, the new National Pro gram was a broad set of guidelines acceptable to all. In it, the FDR had won acceptance of the principle that the Republic could establish relations with any foreign country without consideration of ideology. Amir’s much-vaunted principle of “people’s defense” was also recognized, without, however, any provision for arming the people. The National Pro gram demanded that the country be free from foreign economic control, but the FDR was unable to force the insertion of the wording “free from US control.”93 With the National Program now passed, the FDR pointed out that a consensus had been forced, and it started again to press for a new government. Its maximum demands were a parliamentary cabinet and 50 percent of the seats for the FDR.94 It was later to express its willingness to support a neutral cabinet led by an independent, Djuanda, and there was even some speculation that the FDR might be willing to participate in a cabinet led by Hatta provided it were parliamentary.95 The Masyumi, however, declared it saw no necessity for a change now that the National Program had been accepted by all. The PNI, as usual, was right in the middle on the issue, continuing its support of the H atta govern ment but willing to see the FDR included.96 Haggling over the FDR demands was still proceeding in mid-August, but chances for agreement did not seem particularly promis ing. The Republic had reached one of those new lows in the alternating periods of tension and calm which marked the upward spiral of crises within the Indonesian revolution. Relations with the Dutch were hostile, but there was no immediate crisis, and while the FDR, Masyumi, and GRR were at each other’s throats, there was no strike or other major question which threatened at any moment to flare into open conflict.
90 Ibid., pp. 18,30; Hatta Speech to Parliament, September 16,1948 (FBIS, September 16,1948). 91 Adam Malik, Sajuti Melik, and Pandu Kartawiguna were released in May. In late July, another group of lower-level people including Trimurti were released; and Sukarno was to issue an amnesty for almost all the remaining Tan Malaka group on August 17. Tan Malaka and Abikusno were not released until September 16. 92 Berita Indonesia, August 3,1948, p. 1. 93 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 139, quoting from the July 16,1948 text o f the Committee on the National Program and a recommendation of the FDR on May 14. 94 Berita Indonesia, July 28 and August 5,1948. 95 Ibid., August 10,1948, p. 1, August 11,1948, p. 1; Police Report, August 20,1948, p. 17. 96 Berita Indonesia, July 3,1948, p. 1; FBIS, July 28,1948, quoting Jogja Voice
50 The Birth o f the MInternational Communist Plot" During June and July, although animosity between the FDR and the government was rising, the FDR was still seen as a purely domestic force. True, it was calling for recogni tion of Russia and for a firmer stance against the Dutch, and against the return of foreign capital. This, however, was fully consistent with the FDR’s strongly nationalistic stance. Everyone recognized the FDR as a very radical party but the Communist Party within it was still small and not particularly influential. Amir, in particular, but also the men about him (Tan Ling Djie, Setiadjit, Abdulmadjid, and Wikana), were seen by the government as troublemakers, but nationalist troublemakers, who were as yet untainted with the specter of Soviet control. By June and July, however, the abstract notion of the existence of a Soviet plot, aimed at seizing control in the newly independent countries of Southeast Asia, had appeared in Indonesia, and by August the “plot theory” seemed to have gained general acceptance in the Indonesian press, at least so far as it concerned countries other than Indonesia. The first real formulation of the “Communist plot” idea to reach the Indonesian press, came in the form of a statement by British High Commissioner Malcolm McDonald in Singapore on June 6. McDonald charged that the Communists, stalemated in Europe, were now turning their efforts to Southeast Asia. The Malayan Communist Party, he said, was at the heart of Malaya’s present security problem.97 By the end of June, the press was carrying stories (originating from the United States) that the Communist Party uprisings in Southeast Asia, specifically in Burma and Malaya, were directed from Moscow and run by men trained in the Soviet Union.98 By early Au gust, the local Communist parties were in open rebellion in Malaya, Burma, and the Phil ippines, and the idea of Soviet direction in these rebellions was firmly fixed in the public mind. However, in the mind of the Indonesians, the Republic of Indonesia was an excep tion. The Chinese-run Star Weekly, discussing the “Soviet Plot” during the week of August 15, argued that it was not yet time for a Communist rising in Indonesia, and wondered if the GRR might not be the vehicle of such a plot once Indonesia’s time came. Berita Indo nesia on the other hand, in a story quoting Andrew Roth, saw FDR activities as part of Communist actions in all of Southeast Asia, even though the FDR was not very influenced by the Communist Party.99 While the moment for Indonesia might not yet have arrived, by August the Indonesians were clearly aware of the “international Communist plot” thesis of Russian-sponsored revolts in Southeast Asia. While no one saw signs of this yet in their country, the signs were not to be long in coming. 97 M erdeka, June 8,1948, p. 4. 98 Berita Indonesia, June 21,1948, p. 1; K engPo, June 21,1948, p. 1. 99 Star Weekfy, August 15,1948, pp. 1 and 4; Berita Indonesia, August 11,1948, p. 4.
Wikana
Setiadjit
Abdulmadjid
Musso
Maj.
.G enDjokosujono
Detachment o f Communist troops in Madiun
Harjono
CHAPTER IV I n t o R e b e l l io n
On August 11,1948, a short, heavyset man with a round smiling face stepped from a new Indonesian Air Force DC-3 which had just landed in Yogyakarta. It was long since the little man had been in Java, but he did not seem to mind that he was totally ignored as reporters clustered around his boss, Suripno, besieging him with questions on the Russian agreement. The little man knew his time would come soon enough. His name was Musso and, as he was to tell Sukarno two days later, he had come back from a long exile in Moscow to “set things straight” in the Indonesian revolution.1 It will probably never be known what sort of orders or authority, if any, Musso carried with him from Moscow. It was soon clear, however, that he brought with him the orthodox international Communist line (the Zhdanov line), and that his return was going to have a momentous effect on Indonesia’s FDR. M usso At 50, Musso was a rotund man with an outgoing manner, overflowing with energy.2 He was also a fiery revolutionary, as was soon to be seen, with little patience for the ways of compromise. Born in Kediri, East Java, in 1897 he received a Dutch education in Jakarta. In the earliest years of the nationalist movement, Musso lived with Sukarno and Alimin at Sarekat Islam leader Tjokroaminoto’s house and had been closely involved in the Sarekat Islam. At the time of the PKI split with the SI, Musso joined the Communists and was soon involved in the planning which led to the unsuccessful Communist revolt against the Dutch in 1926 and 1927. Musso was a fervent supporter of the rebellion and traveled with Alimin to Moscow in 1926 to try to gain Comintern support for the plan which was being strongly opposed by Tan Malaka. The Comintern’s reply was an un equivocal no: the imperialist camp was too strong and this was not the moment for revolu tion. To make sure that such deviationist thoughts would not crop up again, Musso and Alimin were ordered to stay on in Moscow for training courses in the meaning of Trotskyist deviation. However, while Alimin was ready to submit to international party discipline, the hotheaded young Musso was not, and he managed secretly to send off a cable ordering the PKI into rebellion.3 There is some question whether Musso’s cable ever arrived, but his action revealed the character of the man who Darsono (another PKI 1 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 18. The statement appeared in the Pesindo paper Revolusioner, August 18,1948, describing M usso’s visit o f August 13 to Sukarno. 2 Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiurt, pp. 36,123. 3 McVey, R ise o f Indonesian Communism, pp. 337-40.
51
52 leader) later remarked had always caused the PKI trouble because of his desire for agita tion.4 The next few years seem to have been uneventful for Musso. He became a staff mem ber of the Comintern in Moscow,5 married and had a son sometime in 1929.6 Little is known of Musso’s activities until 1935 when he was again given a task to his liking. He was sent to Surabaya to reorganize the PKI which had atrophied since 1927. The underground (“illegal”) PKI organization which Musso set up in accordance with the Dimitrov line was to infiltrate and work with Indonesian nationalist organizations. These new activities of the PKI quickly came to the attention of the ever-vigUant Dutch, who swept down to cap ture and exile many of Musso’s new PKI members to Boven Digul in West Irian. Musso himself, however, had returned to Moscow before the sweep began.7 The remnants of this underground PKI organization, after ten years of attacks by the Dutch and Japanese, was then incorporated into the new PKI, set up first under Jusuf in 1945 and then under the more moderate leadership of Sardjono and Alimin in 1946. However, the memory of the 1935 PKI lasted and was to give Musso added legitimacy in PKI circles when he returned to Indonesia in 1948.® After 1935, Musso again vanished into the mists of Moscow and does not seem to have held a position of any great importance.9 Certainly he did not follow the colorful career that led Alimin through Mao’s Yenan and Ho’s Hanoi. Musso next reappears in Prague helping Suripno work out the details of the USSR-Indonesian consular agreement. Ac cording to BinUmgMerah in 1951 (a somewhat dubious source), Musso went to Prague in early November 1947 and had the key role in initiating the talks.10 According to Suripno, however, Musso did not come to Prague until March of 1948 after the talks were already under way.11 Musso remained with Suripno in Prague until June 21,1948, when they both departed for Indonesia, Musso traveling incognito as Mr. Suparto to avoid the difficulties
4 Voice o f Free Indonesia, November 11,1948, pp. 1-2. 5 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 13, describes this period and says Musso joined the Comintern. 6 M erdeka, November 13,1948, pp. 1-2, includes information on Musso’s family. 7 Sidik Kertapati, Sefdiar Proklam asi 17 Augustus 1945 (Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1964), pp. 4-5. The tale o f M usso’s return to Indonesia seem s to have been generally accepted, even though Tan Malaka’s followers at tempted to circulate the story that it was not really Musso who returned in 1935 but a lower functionary using the same name. (Djamaluddin Tamin, SedjarahPKI, xerox copy, Cornell Library, p. 109.) 8 There is controversy over the composition of this group of underground PKI. Musso told Suara Ibu K ota (August 14, 1948) shortly after his return that the illegal PKI was led by Djokosudjono (not to be confused with Maj. Gen. Djokosujono of the TNI Masyarakat), Pamudji, and Achmad Sumadi (Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 28). Pamudji was killed by the Japanese, but Sumadi and Djokosudjono were active on M usso’s return. Amir Sjarifuddin was later to say that he too had been recruited in 1935, but there is room for doubt on this (Berita Indonesia, September 1, 1948, p. 1, quoting an A ntara interview with Amir). However, Amir did work very closely with the Surabaya group of the underground PKI during the Japanese Occupation, and by this time seem s to have begun to consider himself one of the group. (Anderson, Java, pp. 205-6.) For the history o f the PKI in the early revolution, 1945-1946, see ibid., pp. 342-47. 9 The PKI historians themselves are notably silent about Musso’s activities in Moscow. Some papers o f the time implied he was merely a radio announcer (MadjaUah M erdeka, September 11,1948, p. 4), and this appar ently is a serious possibility, as Musso’s activities in 1926 may have incurred Russian distrust. 10 Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 48. 11 Suripno, “Tulisan dari Pendjara Sala” in Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 79, written after his capture in late 1948. This would make more sense. Musso probably either heard of Suripno’s approach and went to Prague to join the action or he was ordered to Prague by Moscow, possibly to help with a language problem.
53 that an ex-Comintern man could be expected to have with Dutch and other authorities along the way. Musso and Suripno reached New Delhi sometime in early June and settled in for a two or three week wait as the Indonesian Air Force completed the purchase of the plane which was to carry them to Indonesia. They then took off again, stopping en route in Thailand and for eight days in Bukittinggi, Sumatra, before reaching Yogyakarta on August 11. Musso apparently remained incognito throughout the trip, not disguising his left-wing af filiations but playing a definite back-seat role to Suripno. (Suripno, on the other hand, apparently met with FDR leaders in Bukittinggi, gave them his ideas on his agreement, and probably briefed them on the new concepts that he and Musso were carrying home to Java.12) Sukarno, when meeting with Musso almost immediately after his arrival, was to de scribe the peppery revolutionary as a “Jago,” a fighting cock, the man who back in the days of Tjokroaminoto’s house most “liked to fight.”13 For once his fighting spirit was in tune with the Moscow line, and in the next few weeks Musso was to show that he had changed little since Sukarno had known him in the early 1920s. One can seriously wonder, how ever, if the rotund revolutionary was any more obedient to Moscow’s command in 1948 than he had been in 1926. “The New Road fo r the Indonesian Republic99 Musso’s arrival in Yogyakarta did not long remain secret. Two days later, on Friday the 13th, he had a friendly meeting with President Sukarno and then immediately plunged into a series of interviews, meetings, and mass rallies which were to continue with mounting intensity until the outbreak at Madiun on September 18. It quickly became apparent that Musso had indeed returned with a new plan for the Indonesian revolution, one which was completely in line with Soviet policy. Where Musso composed this plan, appropriately entitled A New Road fo r the Indonesian Republic, is not clear. Perhaps it was in Prague under Russian supervision, or perhaps on the long route home. In any case, the plan, ac cording to Suripno, was conceived well before the two reached Java.14 After meeting with the PKI Politbureau on August 13-14, Musso was apparently able to gain their acceptance for his “new path.”15 Musso’s ideas on foreign affairs were then put
12 K engP o, August 13,1948, p. 2, quoting “Voice of Free Indonesia” radio broadcast from Bukittinggi. 13 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 17, from Revolusioner, August 1948. 14 Ibid., p. 79. 15 Bintang M erah, May/June 1951, p. 260. It was later said that Musso referred to his ideas “as his ‘Gottwald Plan’ making it clear that he intended to duplicate in Indonesia what Gottwald had just accomplished in Czechoslovakia,” i.e., the peaceful takeover of the government through the Parliament and by control o f the labor unions, army, and police. (Kahin, N ationalism , p. 275.) While the analogy with Czechoslovakia was much used in the press after the Madiun coup (by the PSI Siasat in late September, and by Schorr in the New York Times M agazine, October 3,1948), little mention of Czechoslovakia was made publicly at least by Musso before the coup. Suripno, in one o f his first speeches to the all-Indonesia youth organization BKPRI on Au gust 14,1948, in calling for the establishment o f a United Front, pointed to Czechoslovakia as an example o f a country with a properly formed United Front. (Berita Indonesia, August 16, 1948, p. 1; M erdeka, August 16, 1948, p. 1.) This comment was also recorded later in M im bar Indonesia (August 28,1948, p. 32) as saying that the parties should correct themselves as had been done in Czechoslovakia. Musso himself seem s only to have mentioned Czechoslovakia in passing: e.g. he once used the example of Czechoslovakia along with East Ger many in talking about land reform to the BTI (Buruh, September 4,1948). It would have been normal, having
54 before the rank and file of the PKI in a mass meeting in Yogyakarta on Sunday, August 22.16 More difficult questions dealing with the internal structure of the PKI, however, were further discussed in plenary session of the Central Committee of the PKI on August 26-27, and were accepted and written up in a formal resolution called Djalan Barn untuk Republic Indonesia (New Road for the Indonesian Republic). Djalan Barn was meant as a public document to be put forth at a new PKI congress which was to be held October 1-3, 1948, at which time the PKI was scheduled to have completed its reorganization.17 The contents of Djalan Barn were quickly made public in the press and speeches of the PKI leaders. It is impossible to tell how much of Musso’s original plan may have been changed in the PKI meetings. What emerges, however, in this 34-page document is the pure Zhdanov line with a few Indonesian overtones.18 The document begins with a critique of the PKI since 1935: after World War II, the PKI went astray. Instead of setting up one strong Communist Party it allowed its strength to be dissipated among the three parties of the Sayap Kiri. This policy weakened the PKI and allowed class enemies to hinder the Com munist Party’s development by setting up all sorts of competing leftist groups.19 The party overestimated the strength of the capitalist world and in its fear gave too many concessions to the imperialists and the bourgeoisie.20 The PKI also failed to put enough emphasis on either labor or the farmers.21 Because of this, the PKI, like Tito’s Yugoslav Communist Party, had become submerged in the National Front and had allowed the leadership of the revolution to slip from its hands.22 To correct all these errors drastic changes would have to be made: the PKI must regain the leadership of the working classes as quickly as possible and the PKI must get “HEGEMONI (the largest strength)” [sic] in the leadership of the national revolution.23 To do this, one legal PKI must be set up and the illegal (underground) PKI leadership be abol ished.24 The organizations controlled by the PKI (Partai Sosialis, Partai Buruh Indonesia) must be merged into the new PKI which would then become the true (only) party of the
just returned from several months in Prague, for Musso to use Czechoslovakia as an example in closed PKI sessions, but no record is available o f this. 16 Berita Indonesia, August 24,1948. Some o f Musso’s ideas had already been published on August 14 in the official PKI paper Suara Ibu K ota and in the Pesindo paper Revolusioner. The meeting on August 22 drew a crowd estimated at about 50,000 onlookers. 17 Bintang Merah, May/June 1951, p. 260; and Keng Po, September 16,1948, p. 1. 18 D jalan B am Untuk Republik Indonesia (Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1953). This is the only available copy o f this document, which was republished after the revolt by the PKI. Ruth McVey comments that it does not seem to have been altered from the original document. (McVey, Soviet View, p. 58.) 19 D jalan Baru^ pp. 7-9. 20 Ibid., p. 9. 21 Ibid., pp. 9-10. 22 Ibid., p. 11. 23 Ibid. 24 Ibid., p. 12. This line reads “. . . mengadakan hanja satu partai jang legal daripada klas buruh. Ini berarti hapuskannja pimpinan PKI jang illegal.”
55 working class.25 This new party must be purged and all its members re-educated to under stand their past mistakes. The paper goes on to criticize Amir for having withdrawn his cabinet “voluntarily and without any resistance [perlawanan] whatsoever.”26 This mistake, it said, had permitted “the rapid growth of a reactionary policy over the last six months since the leadership has been held by elements of the bourgeois compradore class.”27 Djalan Bam stresses that the PKI alone cannot succeed in the revolution and therefore a “National Front” including other parties must be formed. But this National Front must be set up from below, all who enter must enter individually, and the PKI must hold the leadership.28 Djalan Bam then went on to enumerate the many social and economic changes it had in mind, which included a thorough-going overhaul of the civil service, police, law courts, and the army, to rid them of feudal elements (e.g. the aristocratic pamong praja civil servants, ex-Dutch-trained soldiers, etc.).29 The PKI also intended to improve the rights of the workers especially by abolishing the H atta government’s restrictions on the workers’ right to strike,30 and to improve the lot of the farmer. (This, Djalan Bam admitted, was not something that could be done overnight as land was short on Java, but what land could be gained by abolishing feudal regulations in Java should be redivided among the poor farmers.31) Djalan Bam then continued much in the fashion of a campaign platform to propose a little bit of something for everyone, even the Chinese.32 Djalan Barn's criticisms of the FDR for ignoring labor and the peasantry were some what unfair. Djalan Bam itself represented little more than a restatement of what the FDR had been demanding both for labor and for peasants over the last two months. Djalan Barn's policy statement, however, put this policy in a clear, dramatic form for the first time. And, while the FDR’s commitment to social revolution in the midst of war against the Dutch had seemed at times more of a tactic than a firmly held principle,33 it was clear from Djalan Bam , that the new PKI line demanded a clear-cut commitment to social reform and to class struggle as a basis, rather than a tactic, of PKI policy. On foreign affairs, Djalan Bam outlined dramatic innovations to bring the PKI com pletely in line with the two-camp thesis of Zhdanov. The Communists, Djalan Bam firmly
25 Ibid., pp. 12-13. 26 Ibid., p. 19. 27 Ibid., p. 26. 28 Ibid., pp. 31-33. If members o f groups enter individually, the paper comments frankly, this will reduce the possibility o f conflict among squabbling parties. (O f course, it would also make it easier for the PKI to control the organization.) 29 Ibid., pp. 26-28. 30 Ibid., p. 28. An interview by Musso in Suara Ibu K ota, August 14,1948, has been used by Derita and others to say that Musso disapproved of Amir’s use of strikes in June and July. It seem s quite clear, however, that Musso simply said to the reporter who questioned him on the use o f strikes that “such actions should be avoided by abolishing the factors which are unsatisfactory to the workers.” (Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 28.) 31 D jalan Barn, p. 29. 32 Ibid., p. 30. 33 Amir, for instance, had not encouraged strikes during his time in office and had acted against the social revolution in Solo. Once out o f power, however, he clearly used the Delanggu strike as a political tactic. In all cases, he was supported by the PKI.
56 announced, repudiate both the Linggajati and Renville agreements not merely because the Dutch have broken the agreements (“no, no, a thousand times no!”).34 The Commu nists repudiate these agreements in principle, because even if their terms were carried out they would not bring real independence to Indonesia. Rather they would bring the form of neo-colonialism which could now be seen in the supposedly independent Burma, India, and the Philippines. The Communists, Djalan Bam stated, demand “full independence.”35 Indonesia, the paper stated flatly, must side with the Soviet Union because the “Soviet Union is the vanguard of the fight against the imperialist bloc which is led by the United States. It is clear to us that the US helps and uses the Dutch to strangle our democratic Republic.”36 In its demand that the Communists take the leadership of the national revolution away from the untrustworthy bourgeoisie and in its call for a strong anti-imperialist stance and for the Republic to side only with the USSR, Musso’s Djalan Bam was a very orthodox Stalinist (Zhdanov line) document. Djalan Barn's demands for greater social reform went little beyond what was already being sought by the FDR. The stress on joining the Russian camp and the claim that the PKI had the right to the leadership of the revolution, however, were new. These were to startle most non-Communist Indonesian observers and horrify the anti-Communists, who immediately began to fear that the “Moscow Plot” had now arrived in Indonesia. The Implementation o f the M usso Plan The PKI almost immediately set out to put Djalan Bam into action, and the transfor mation of the PKI which ensued led to much speculation as to why the PKI (and FDR) had so quickly accepted Musso and his new line. On Sunday, August 22, Musso addressed a huge PKI rally in Yogyakarta calling for denunciation of Renville and Linggajati and recognition of the USSR. The Dutch, Musso said, were thieves and pirates; their blows must be returned with blows because “with imperialism it is impossible to compromise.” Relations with Russia would open the Dutch blockade, because the Dutch would not dare stop Russian ships, and even the US would be hesitant if it knew the Republic was under USSR protection.37 Resolutions were then put before the meeting, which, inspired by Musso’s vibrant oratory, were enthusiastically approved. These resolutions condemned Dutch treachery and demanded a halt to talks with the Dutch. Consuls should be ex changed with the USSR and a “National Front Government” set up for the Republic. That evening, the presidium of SOBSI, at a meeting immediately following Musso’s speech, came out with a new platform which fell into line with the Djalan Bam : it de nounced Renville/Linggajati, and called for relations with the USSR and other East Euro pean countries and for the establishment of a National Front government which SOBSI announced it would enter. It also took a very harsh line in calling for nationalization of
34 D jalan Barn, p. 23. 35 Ibid. 36 Ibid., p. 24. 37 Berita Indonesia, August 24,1948, p. 1.
57 property belonging to enemies of the Republic, for land to the peasants, and for prepara tion of a scorched earth policy to meet the Dutch threat.38 On August 31, the PKI made the change which was to set its course straight for Madiun. Following the plan accepted by the Central Committee on August 26-27, the PKI announced the merger of the Partai Sosialis and Partai Buruh Indonesia with the PKI, and the dissolution of the FDR. To the surprise, dismay, and at times disbelief of many ob servers, underground PKI members (including Amir, Setiadjit, Abdulmadjid, Wikana, Tan Ling Djie, and others) then stepped forward to admit their Communist affiliations, and a new PKI Politbureau which included most of the top underground members was now announced:39 General Secretariat: Musso, Maruto Darusman, Tan Ling Djie, Ngadiman Labor Secretariat: A. Tjokronegoro, Aidit, Sutrisno Youth Secretariat: Wikana, Suripno Women’s Secretariat: (temporarily managed by the General Secretariat) Defense Secretariat: Amir Sjarifuddin Propaganda-Agitation Secretariat: Lukman, Alimin, Sardjono Organization Secretariat: Sudisman Occupied Territories Secretariat: (managed by the General Secretariat) Secretariat of Foreign Affairs: Suripno Representation Secretariat: Njoto Cadre Secretariat: (managed by the General Secretariat) Financial Secretariat: Ruskak. In the space of three short weeks, Musso had managed to transform the loosely struc tured conglomeration of left-wing organizations in the FDR into a new centrally con trolled Communist Party which promised, in the next few weeks, to purge and tighten its control over its members. All wanted to know how Musso had managed this. Was this simply the spectacle of a monolithic Communist Party bowing to orders from Moscow, or were there other elements involved? At this point, the magical question of “orders from Moscow” always arises, and it is a question which will probably never be answered. Stalin had received a severe shock in late June of 1948 when relations with Tito became so strained that it was necessary to expel him from the Cominform. Titoism quickly became anathema to the Soviet Union, and the Soviets set about tightening their control over other national Communist parties, espe cially those in Eastern Europe which could scarcely escape the Soviet reach. The Soviets were determined to reassert their absolute leadership in the Communist world and to make certain that no other Communist parties followed the path of the heretical Tito.40 Musso was obviously fully apprised of the Soviet line on Tito, as can be seen in his refer ences to Tito in Djalan Bam . It is extremely likely that the Russians were using him as
38 Ibid. The SOBSI decision was evidently made by its PKI-controlled Central Committee and was to cause serious problems over the next two weeks in non-PKI-dominated SOBSI branch unions. 39 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 276. From Suara Ibu K ota, September 1,1948. 40 McVey, Soviet View, pp. 52-54; Jan F. Triska and David D . Finley, Soviet Foreign Policy (New York: Macmil lan, 1968), p. 2; Franz Borkenau, European Communism (New York: Harper, 1953); Ulam, Expansion and Co existence, pp. 463-66.
58 their instrument to bring the Indonesian Communist Party into line with other parts of the Soviet-controlled world Communist movement. (As Ruth McVey points out, Indonesia at this time was the only country in Southeast Asia where the Communist Party was not fully in harmony with the two-camp line.41) Musso had worked for the Comintern, and while the organization was officially dissolved in 1943, there is no reason to believe that he did not simply continue in the work elsewhere in the Russian bureaucracy. On the other hand, Moscow could not have had detailed knowledge of the Indonesian situation, and Musso must have had a great deal of leeway in interpreting the general guidelines of Soviet policy that Communist parties and national movements must side with the Soviet camp and Communist parties must lead the national revolution. Musso himself repeatedly denied that he had any orders from Moscow, but his party was not at all loath to stress that here was a man direct from Moscow with “International Communist creden tials.”42 Whatever his official relationship to Moscow, Musso undoubtedly played this to the hilt within PKI councils for it would be his main card to gain the acceptance of the PKI leadership. It is hard to see a Mao Tse Tung or a Ho Chi Minh meekly accepting orders from Moscow at this time, and whether or not the same might have been the case for Indonesia under other circumstances is open to question. Musso’s return, however, hit the PKI at a very opportune moment. Relations with the Dutch were steadily deteriorating, and the FDR was already giving little more than lip service to the Renville Agreements and then only as “a basis” for negotiations. Musso’s Djalati Barn gave the party an excellent theo retical excuse (and one which was also honorable) for dropping their last subservience to the two pacts which they, embarrassingly, had negotiated.43 The FDR had already been calling for relations with the Soviets and Djalan Barn simply served to sharpen their argu ments. The same, of course, was true of their approach to labor and the peasantry, al though they were forced to swallow the bitter pill of self-criticism on these issues. More importantly perhaps, it was becoming obvious that the FDR was not winning the battle with Hatta. The PKI, which since the departure of the PSI had been given a free field to consolidate its position in the FDR organizations, now had fairly firm control. The FDR organization, however, was unwieldly, and to firmly committed Communists it must have been a relief to be told that they could now abandon subterfuge and create one cleancut organization. At the time of Musso’s return and later there was much speculation over his relation ship to other PKI leaders, and the idea inevitably arose that Musso was simply being used
41 McVey, Soviet View, p. 54. 42 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 16, from Revolusioner, August 19,1948; Berita Indonesia, September 14,1948, p. 1. 43 According to PSI paper Sikap (September 8,1948), p. 4, up until Musso’s arrival the FD R attitude had been “Renville djangan dikurangi” (“don’t downgrade Renville”). In the beginning of October 1948, Masyumi Min ister o f Information Natsir told an AP correspondent that “only after Musso returned did the Indonesian Communist Party adopt a policy of militant opposition both to the government of Mohammad Hatta and to further negotiations with the Dutch” (Straits Times, October 3,1948, p. 1). A lso see Aidit, Short History o f the Com m unist P a rty, p. 30, for the PKI’s rejection o f Renville after Musso’s return. The latest FD R statements which seem available on this subject are an Amir interview with A neta on June 11, in which he stated that FD R disagreement with Hatta on internal policy did not mean he objected to Hatta’s foreign policy toward Renville (Berita Indonesia, June 12,1948), and an Amir speech o f June 15 (?) stating that Renville only represented an agreement to talk with the Dutch. (Ibid., June 15,1948.)
59 by various groups within the FDR to further their own ends. It is very clear that the old PKI leadership of Alimin and Sardjono was ruthlessly shouldered aside in Musso’s take over. They both ended up holding insignificant positions in the Propaganda-Agitation Secretariat under the relative newcomer Lukman. The theory most often heard in August and September 1948 was the Murba-inspired one that Musso was being used by Amir to shore up his faltering FDR, and that indeed Musso (who should, according to the Murba liturgy, have joined Tan Malaka’s forces) was practically being held incommunicado by Amir.44 This last was plainly nonsense, as from the very first Musso made it clear to the press that he considered Tan Malaka a Trotskyite.45 Why Amir was willing to step aside for Musso, however, is far from clear. If Amir had simply been using Musso for his own purposes, he would certainly have kept more power in his own hands. Instead, he stood aside for the older PKI leadership of Musso and M aruto Darusman. It may be that Amir, while considering himself a Commu nist, had never been forced to submit to party discipline, and had never held any formal place in the party's hierarchy. When Musso returned, with the authority of Moscow (real or imagined) behind him, Amir was faced with losing control over the FDR organization, which was now almost completely Communist controlled, or really joining the party. The PKI for its part needed Amir for his connections with the military and his credentials as one of the top revolutionary leaders. It is plain, however, that the PKI too must have re garded Amir as a party member or he would never have been given control over the party's strategic Defense Secretariat.46* Musso may also have used the support of competing factions in the PKI to win accep tance of his candidacy and program. It is, however, hard to identify factions in the old PKI leadership, and even harder to sort out power relationships in the new Politbureau. Ac cording to Soe Hok Gie, who did a detailed study of the PKI in the 1930s and early 1940s, it had basically three groups: those centered around Sardjono and the PKI SIBAR (exBoven Digul prisoners who had spent the war in Australia working for the Allies); the elite Dutch-trained Communists (Maruto Darusman, Abdulmadjid, Setiadjit, and Tan Ling Djie) who returned to Indonesia just after the war; and the younger, and for the most part more radical, Indonesian-educated Communists epitomized by Aidit, Lukman, and Njoto. To try and find power patterns in the Politbureau either before or after Musso’s return is very difficult. Many of the PKI’s top leaders in early 1948 were of course underground and not represented on the “legal” PKI's ruling Politbureau. Because of this, their actual relations to the Politbureau, if indeed they were formalized, are impossible to determine. However, in early 1948, both the PKI SIBAR (Sardjono) and some of the Dutch group
44 M erdeka, September 21,1948, p. 2, September 9,1948, p. 1. Rustam Effendi, a member o f the Dutch Com munist Party who defected to Tan Malaka on his return to Indonesia, was the sponsor o f this line. 45 Derita, U m a Minggu, p. 31. From a Suara Ibu K ota stoiy on August 14,1948, “Musso firmly stated that Tan Malaka was indeed a Trotskyist who does not acknowledge the important place o f the peasantiy in the class struggle.” 46 A lso see Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 273-75. All this is, o f course, highly speculative. M erdeka went so far as to accuse Amir o f joining the PKI for protection from revenge by Tan Malaka who was about to be released from jail. (M erdeka, September 3, 1948, p. 3.) A fter the Madiun coup, the Indonesian government information agencies stressed the “Moscow plot” thesis as an explanation for the coup. A t the same time, however, in midOctober, the Ministry o f Information was laying full blame for the coup on Amir rather than Musso, who, after all, had just arrived. (See Persatoean, October 15,1948, p. 4.)
60 (Maruto Darusman) were in the “legal” PKI leadership, and the younger group of Aidit and company was already working its way upward.47 When the Njoto-Lukman-Aidit triumverate took over the PKI in 1951, they did their best to clear the name of Musso in Indonesia, and this has given rise to the speculation that they considered themselves as Musso supporters.48 Certainly Musso’s fiery philosophy would have appealed to these young activist-oriented PKI members, and all three did gain positions on the new Politbureau. On the other hand, the top leadership in the General Secretariat contained Maruto Darusman and Tan Ling Djie (both Dutch trained) and Ngadiman. On the whole, how ever, Musso’s Politbureau, while including most of the older PKI leaders, did have a much younger and more dynamic cast than the previous Alimin/Sardjono group. Undoubtedly Musso did use splits in the PKI leadership to gather support, and his stat ure as an international Communist figure with credentials from Moscow must have been crucial in making him acceptable to the PKI. However, Musso himself does seem to have been an inspirational leader, and he arrived with a clear, well-conceived plan which had the prestige of international communism behind it, at a time when the left wing was quite plainly in need of new directions. PK I Into Action Once the new structure of the PKI was announced, the party swung into action, first to carry out the purges and restructuring necessary to merge the FDR parties and organiza tions into the consolidated PKI, and second to tour the countryside to explain the changes and to stir up mass support for them. The PKI leaders were aware that complete reor ganization of the party would be no easy task, but they hoped to have this completed be fore the party congress planned for October 1-3.49 The integration of the FDR seemed to go well at first. The Partai Sosialis announced its fusion with the PKI on August 31, and on September 4-5, a Central Committee meeting of the PBI approved its Politbureau’s decision to merge.50 On August 31, Antara an nounced that SOBSI also intended to “follow the PKI” (berhaluan PKI pula) and on Sep tember 3, Pesindo, meeting in plenary session in Solo also voted to join the PKI.51* Only the BTI, the PSI-controlled farmers organization which held its congress in Yogyakarta
47 Aidit, 24 years old, was in early 1948 a candidate member o f the PKI Politbureau, on the executive commit tee o f the FDR, and chairman o f the PKI parliamentary group. Lukman, at 28, was a member o f the PKI Cen tral Committee, and Njoto, at 23, was chairman o f the PKI group in the Working Committee o f the Parlia ment. (See Hindley, Comm unist Party, pp. 23-24.) 48 Aidit told Ruth McVey that the younger group of PKI leaders felt themselves generally ignored and looked down on by the top leftist leadership as rather unsophisticated young hot heads. Dr. McVey felt that one of the reasons the Aidit leadership, on coming to power in 1951, made rehabilitation of Musso a major point of emphasis was that they were associated with him and had been given a chance by Musso to rise in the PKI. (M cVey letter to the author, July 15,1972.) 49 According to a conversation between Professor Kahin and Suripno on September 1, 1948, Suripno stated that only 30,000 of the 60,000 Partai Sosialis members and half the smaller PBI would actually be allowed to join the new PKI. Kahin, however, speculates that “this selection o f members may well have been in large part a rationalization of the fact that considerable portions of the membership of both the Socialist and Labor par ties in Java were opposed to such a fusion with the PKI.” (Kahin, N ationalism , p. 227.) 50 FBIS, September 1,1948, quoting Yogyakarta radio (A ntara) August 31,1948; Buruh, September 6,1948. 51 Berita Indonesia, September 1,1948, p. 1 and September 4,1948, p. 2; also M erdeka, September 4,1948, p. 1, which says the decision was taken September 2,1948.
61 during the first week of September, was noticeably cool to the new PKI and made no motion to join.52 According to George Kahin, however, parts of both the Partai Sosialis and the PBI were opposed to the merger and problems became quickly apparent.53 Mod erates in the FDR, especially outside East and Central Java, were uneasy, and there may have even been problems within the PKI itself from those members who advocated a small well-trained elite PKI and who were now very unhappy to be faced with a huge expansion of the PKI membership by newcomers with little or no training.54 Yet more problems arose with SOBSI, some of whose member unions protested against the statements of their PKI-controlled leadership and demanded that a SOBSI congress be held quickly to discuss these new issues.55 Workers in the Ministry of Communications withdrew from SOBSI in protest on September 10, but more radical organizations like the Sugar Work ers’ Association (Sarekat Buruh Gula) in Solo remained firmly on the PKI side.56 Pesindo, too, seemed united in its decision to support the PKI, although PSI minister Supeno’s ef forts among the Pesindo youth may have had a disruptive effect.57 All in all, the PKI lead ership in early September does seem to have been aware that a great deal of work both organizationally and through indoctrination would be necessary before the new PKI could be thought of as a trustworthy organization.58 In an effort to explain the new PKI line to followers and to garner new support, Musso and other Communist leaders immediately launched a series of mass meetings and speeches. On September 3, Musso addressed the BTI; on the 5th, he met with students; and on the 7th, Musso and a team of high-ranking PKI leaders including Amir, Setiadjit, and Wikana left for a two week tour of Central and East Java which, before it was cut short by the Madiun revolt on the 18th, had given them the opportunity to speak before the mass meetings in Solo (7th), Madiun (8th), Kediri (11th), Jombang (13th), Bojonegoro (14th), Cepu (16th), and Purwodadi, where the group arrived on the afternoon of the 17th.59 The only way to describe Musso’s speeches in these meetings is incendiary. They were the speeches of the true revolutionary calling for the revolution, now. The best ex ample of Musso’s style comes from his dramatic performance at a mass rally in Madiun on September 8. Here Musso was in one of the bastions of left-wing support and he per-
52 The dates o f the congress are a bit hazy. Sutter, Indonesianisasi, p. 567, puts the dates at September 4-6, but M usso addressed the BTI on September 3, before leaving for a campaign swing through Java (M erdeka, Sep tember 6,1948), and Sudirman addressed the meeting on September 7 (ibid., September 10,1948). The fact Musso did not stay in town for the main part o f the meeting and the rostrum o f speakers, including Catholic Party leader Kasimo and Sudirman, is probably an indication o f the BTTs more conservative stance. 53 Kahin, N ationalism an d Revolution, p. 277. 54 Berita Indonesia, September 9,1948, p. 1. 55 Ibid., September 14, 1948, p. 1; the Serikat Buruh Mobil Indonesia and Serikat Buruh Jawatan Angkatan M otor R.I. (both auto drivers’ associations) called for this action September 11-12. 56 Ibid; Derita, L im a Minggu, pp. 35-39, quoting Solo, September 8,1948. 57 P olice Report, August 20, 1948, pp. 64-65. According to the Report, Supeno used funds available to him as minister to win support away from Pesindo leader Sumarsono. Supeno also managed to have the coordinating student body BKPRI appoint one o f his followers chairman (Sumarsono was vice chairman) and move BKPRI headquarters to Yogyakarta from Madiun where it was too much under the control o f the FDR. Thus FD R influence in this all-Indonesian student organization was decreased. 58 Both Amir and Suripno, after their arrest, were to point to the fact that the party was still in the midst o f its reorganization plans at the time of Madiun as proof that they had not planned a coup for that date (see H idup, December 18,1948, p. 3 and Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 86). 59 Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 54.
62 formed well for his appreciative audience. The Indonesian revolution, he said, had not fared well over the last three years because it had fallen into the hands of the bourgeoisie. The proletariat must recapture the leadership if the revolution was to succeed. Only if the revolution was led by the PKI would normal conditions be achieved. The economy must be reorganized and the present aristocratic system (ningrat) changed. The Republic must recognize Russia and must denounce the Renville/Linggajati agreements. The H atta government’s “bootlicking” attitude toward the United States had only resulted in Ameri can support for the Dutch, and if this policy were continued it would carry the Republic into a new colonialism. The first strategy should be to fight the Dutch “to kill as many Dutchmen as possible, and to seize their weapons.” The PKI honored religion, but if Moslems did not wish to be oppressed, now was the time for the Perang Sabil (Holy War).«0 Musso’s strong stance, while gravely exacerbating an already tense situation, was well received by his audiences. Economic conditions in the Republic, due to the Dutch block ade, were disastrous, especially in the cities. Inflation was soaring: in one year rice had risen to ten and one half times its original price.61 Everything was in critically short supply, from medicines, bandages, and textiles to housing and food. In a hard-driving revolution, hardships are expected, but the Indonesian revolution had been stalemated for over six months at the conference table, and the Republic’s elan was slipping badly. This had be come so evident that the PSI paper, Siasat, on August 29, openly commented on the low morale in Yogyakarta.62 Musso’s fiery oratory was a breath of fresh air to many radical revolutionaries. He was at long last offering a clearcut solution to the Republic’s ills—a solution which not only had the aura of an inevitable world revolution behind it but also one which was very much to their liking. Musso’s strong uncompromising stance against the Dutch was particularly popular at this point, for relations with the Dutch seemed, at long last, to be reaching the real break ing point. On August 16, Dutch (ethnic Chinese) police fired on a group of boy scouts ille gally celebrating Indonesian National Day at the office of the Indonesian delegation in Jakarta. Three were killed, and this incident so incensed the Republic that the Parliament passed a resolution calling for a halt to the talks until a full apology was made. The Dutch, however, adding insult to injury, replied by evicting all Republican officials from Jakarta and other parts of Dutch-held Indonesia, and then by taking over an Indonesian-run hos pital on August 24. “Illegal” Indonesian guerrilla attacks against the Dutch in West Java had evidently increased dramatically in August. On September 7, as Musso’s campaign was reaching its height, Dutch East Java military commander Major General Baay pre cipitated a real crisis. Baay issued an ultimatum demanding that guerrilla attacks cease in his areas within 48 hours. If they did not, he would request permission to take further action, which, he indicated, would mean sending his troops into Republican-held territory. As the H atta government protested the Dutch ultimatum, the PKI immediately issued an appeal on September 11 calling for people to be prepared to meet the Dutch with a
60 B enia Indonesia, September 14,1948, p. 1. Berita Indonesia was quoting the Dutch news service A neta which in this case would seem to have been accurate in its reporting, as Musso’s comments hold closely to the line set forth in D jalan B an t and in interviews he gave in the Communist press. See also M erdeka, September 15,1948, p. 2 and “Sifat Revolusi Kita” in Revolusioner, September 5,1948 (Derita, L im a Minggu, pp. 19-22). 61 Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 177, gives figures on inflation. The rice price rose from Rp 1.66 to Rp 17.50 in one year. 62 Siasat, August 29,1948, p. 1.
63 scorched-earth policy.63 All of this naturally did nothing to increase the popularity of H atta’s efforts to negotiate with the Dutch, and Musso’s insinuations that H atta was sell ing the country out to them were probably quite effective. The Specter o f the “Moscow Plot" Musso’s return and the sudden transformation of the PKI amazed and horrified many Indonesians. At first, Musso’s return was simply greeted with interest, as the return of an old revolutionary hero who might even be able to calm down the left wing.64 However, as Musso overnight transformed the PKI from a badly led, innocuous organization of 3,000 to a mass-based party including the powerful armed fighting unit Pesindo and a massive la bor wing (SOBSI), the suspicion dawned that the “red menace” had finally reached Indo nesia. Indeed, here was Musso, fresh from Moscow, doubtlessly carrying orders from the Soviets to set off Communist revolution in Indonesia. When the Communists would rebel was only a question of time. The above sketch is, needless to say, extreme. It does, however, convey much of the atmosphere in the Indonesian press after September 1. Already well indoctrinated in the theory of the “Moscow plot” for Southeast Asia, non-Communist Indonesians were now fully prepared to condemn without trial the intentions of Musso’s new Communist Party. Statements by Musso repeating the Communist liturgy that “the bourgeoisie is no longer capable of leading a real anti-imperialist independence struggle”65 and that “the party [PKI] is the commander of the proletariat in seizing the power of the state,”66 did little to assuage non-Communist fears. The Dutch naturally took the lead in pointing to Musso’s perfidy. On August 25, their radio was broadcasting the tale that twenty Russians had accompanied Musso as far as Bangkok, where they had been forced to deplane because the Republic had refused them permission to enter.67 By September 3, official Dutch spokesmen were accusing Suripno and Musso of having “clear instructions from Moscow” which they were now carrying out.68 On September 5, the New York Times amplified this with a story from Singapore that renewal of warfare in Indonesia was likely, especially by the PKI which, with the coop eration of the army, might try a coup against Hatta.69 The Indonesian press in both Yogyakarta and Jakarta, on the other hand, did not become really concerned until after the formation of the new PKI. By September 2, however, Berita Indonesia in Jakarta was carrying editorial pleas to the Dutch to be more forthcoming in their dealings with the Hatta government in order to help undercut the PKI’s popularity. Indonesia, the paper
63 Berita Indonesia, September 13,1948, p. 1. The Dutch often protested Indonesian “scorched-earth” tech niques which consisted of setting up explosives beside equipment in factories and on the estates to destroy Dutch property in case o f Dutch aggression. 64 M erdeka, August 30,1948, p. 1. 65 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 21, quoting from an article by Musso in Revolusioner, September 5,1948. 66 Suara Ibu K ota, September 2,1948, from an editorial by Musso. 67 FBIS, August 26, 1948, quoting Radio Batavia broadcasting in English August 25, 1948. The stoiy was promptly denied by Suripno, August 28,1948. 68 Berita Indonesia, September 3,1948, p. 2. Musso repeatedly denied this accusation (see Berita Indonesia, September 2,1948, p. 1). 69 N ew York Times, September 5,1948, p. 31.
64 said, does not wish to become a second Burma or Malaya, “another battle ground of com munism.”70 The Republic’s news service Antara on September 1 wondered if the govern ment would take harsh steps against the PKI which had so changed its attitude since Musso’s arrival, and the Masyumi paper Guntur the same day asked the PKI if there was already a plan to appoint Musso “dictator of the Proletariat.”71 This was only the begin ning of the reaction. By September 11, the press was showing distinct traces of hysteria. On September 9, Merdeka encouraged Hatta to use his “iron fist” (a reference to his Sep tember 2 speech, see below) to subdue the opposition if it went beyond the pale, and on September 11, Madjalah Merdeka,, warning of the dangers if the Hatta government did not act quickly against the PKI, said that “if we intend to stand firmly between the fire and Satan, one of them must be destroyed.”72 The government’s reaction to the transformation of the PKI was very firm. On Septem ber 2, Hatta made a lengthy speech to the KNIP, discussing the complaints of the left wing and the “state of the nation” and issuing a firm warning against further left-wing “disor ders.” The speech, which Hatta had apparently cleared with his principal military com manders, shows his firm grasp of Communist ideology and tactics and of the Communist line as it was then issuing from Moscow.73 Hatta first discussed the sudden change in FDR policy, from a defense “to the death” of Renville to the demand that Renville be revoked. Then pointing to the FDR’s demand that Indonesia side with the Soviet camp, he argued for a neutral policy that would prevent Indonesia from becoming an “object in the conflict of international politics” between Russia and the United States. Communist ideology, H atta pointed out, forced Communists around the world unerringly to follow Moscow for, according to Communist doctrine, the success or failure of the world revolution hinges on the success or failure of the Soviet Union in staving off the rapacious forces of imperial ism. This meant, as in 1939 when Stalin entered the non-aggression pact with Nazi Ger many, that Communists around the world were supposed to follow the Soviet line no mat ter whether that line went directly against the national interests of their countries or not. Unlike the Communists, H atta pointed out, a true nationalist works for the good of his own country and refuses to choose sides between the US and the USSR.74 H atta then went on to discuss what his government was doing to meet the social and economic problems faced by the Republic, and why, in some areas, such as land and labor, these problems were not subject to instant cures. Hatta strongly criticized PKI demands for immediate social revolution, pointing out that Communist theory itself demanded the national revolution be completed before full social revolution could be begun. “The aim [strength] of our revolution will be split if it is interfered with by the aims of the social revolution.”75
70 Berita Indonesia, September 2,1948, p. 1. Berita Indonesia was a Jakarta paper. 71 M erdeka, September 2, 1948, p. 1; Guntur, September 1, 1948. Both A ntara and Guntur were published in Yogyakarta. 72 M adjalah M erdeka, September 11,1948, p. 4. (Published in Jakarta.) 73 The only reference to Hatta receiving support from Sudirman and “principal division commanders” before his speech comes from Bernhard Dahm, The H istory o f Indonesia in the Twentieth Century (New York: Praeger, 1971), p. 134. This reference is not footnoted, but Dahm should probably be given the benefit o f the doubt as this sounds very likely. 74 Hatta, “Speech to Parliament,” September 2,1948, in Facta dan Dokumen2, vol. 2, pt. 7, p. 10. 75 Ibid., pp. 11-20.
65 H atta’s speech was a very clear exposition of his government’s position on Social Revo lution versus National Revolution, and showed H atta’s absolute determination to prevent the success of Musso’s campaign to haul Indonesia into the midst of the Cold War on the side of the Russians. As far as the PKI was concerned, the most important part of the speech was the harsh warning which H atta issued at the speech’s end: Often in a new democracy boundaries are crossed and excesses arise. During these excesses, which are a form of Kindergartenism or Radical ism, the government will be patient and this attitude will often seem like weakness. However, if this Kindergarten-ism goes too far across the boundaries using intimidation and giving rise to anarchy to the point that the security of the nation is threatened, then the government will make corrections. If necessary, these corrections will be carried out with an iron fist.76 The significance of H atta’s warning was lost on neither right nor left. Over the next week, cries rose from government supporters for H atta to use his “iron fist” against the PKI, whose mass rallies were raising the tempers of PKI supporters to fever pitch. However, in the midst of all the furor, on September 9,1948, the PKI issued an invita tion to the Masyumi and the PNI to meet with them to discuss the possibility of setting up a National Front government. The idea by this time of the Masyumi joining the PKI in any form of cooperation was mildly ridiculous, and the PKI’s invitation was probably meant both as a propaganda move to put the parties in the position of being against “national unity” and as a last ditch effort to win the vacillating PNI to the PKI side. At a meeting on September 4-5, the Masyumi leadership council had issued a strongly anti-Communist statement fully supporting the H atta government. While calling for the Republic to widen its contacts abroad, the statement stressed the Masyumi’s determination to oppose “Communism and Imperialism” and to help the government in steps against “destructive elements.”77 On September 10, the Masyumi flatly refused the PKI’s invitation, pointing out (quite correctly from their point of view) that the PKI was untrustworthy. After all, the Masyumi observed, Musso had said publicly that he only intended to use the PNI and Masyumi for the moment. Later the PKI would rule alone.78 The Masyumi then an nounced its decision to set up a “front Islam” with another small Moslem party, the PSII (Partai Sarekat Islam Indonesia), once an ally of Amir, to oppose the PKI. As usual the PNI’s position was not as sharply defined as that of the Masyumi, and the PNI waited until September 13 to give its negative reply to the PKI. Energetic FDR/PKI agitation in the villages and against the aristocratic classes (kaum ningrat) had undoubt edly already alienated much of the PNI members’ good will toward its more radical abangan comrades. On September 11, before its reply to the PKI was given, the PNI par ticipated in a mass rally (50,000) in Yogyakarta with the Masyumi to support H atta and to counter PKI rallies going on all over the country. The rally called for H atta to throw off his restraint in dealing with the PKI, and signs carried by demonstrators (probably Masyumi) called for H atta to show his “iron fist” and for Indonesia to be tied neither to 76 Ibid., p. 24. 77 Berita Indonesia, September 7, 1948, p. 1; FBIS, September 7, 1948, quoting Radio Yogyakarta (A ntara) September 6,1948. 78 Berita Indonesia, September 11, p. 1; Guntur, September 16,1948.
66 Washington nor Moscow.79 By the 13th, then, when the first real clashes started to occur between government forces and the PKI, both the Masyumi and PNI were firmly ranged against the Communists. For the first week in September, however, the real battle raged not between the PKI and Masyumi/PNI but between the PKI and its old Tan Malaka enemies gathered in the Gerakan Revolusi Rakyat (GRR). The government, as everyone was plainly aware at the time, was using the GRR to counterbalance the FDR/PKI on the left, and, if possible, to take some of the wind out of the FDR sails. However, using these radical national Com munists was like playing with fire, and it is questionable if the GRR was ever really under firm government control. Before Tan Malaka’s release the GRR leader was Dr. Muwardi, the popular leader of the Solo-based lasykar, Barisan Banteng. Muwardi was very close to Sukarno, and this relationship seems to have lasted into 1948. In Solo, the GRR had long been the chief opponent of the FDR/PKI, and this apparently was a major factor in the vague friendship which existed between the Masyumi and the Barisan Banteng and for the Barisan’s near alliance with the Siliwangi Division, as both were also strongly anti-FDR.80 The unlikely alliance between the GRR and the Hatta government had not begun in earnest until early August. Up until this time, the GRR had opposed both the H atta gov ernment and the Renville Agreements. Now, on August 5, it completely reversed itself and suddenly announced its support of the Hatta government.81 It is difficult to tell what bargain was struck to achieve this result, but from this time forward the government started mass releases of Tan Malaka supporters, culminating on September 16 in the an nouncement that Tan Malaka himself would be released. The GRR was not at all op posed to the use of “illegal” methods to achieve its goal of pushing the Indonesian revolu tion into more radical paths, and its use of fake documents and the tactics of kidnapping and terrorism were well known.8283 The day after the PKI announcement, the GRR, too, issued a statement that it had reorganized its governing body. On the same day, Septem ber 2, Dr. Muwardi held “secret” (i.e., not fully reported) talks with Sukarno and H atta for an hour. It was this meeting, which may have simply been to inform Sukarno of the new GRR organization, that was later used by the PKI to “prove” that Muwardi was plotting with H atta and Sukarno to cause a “provocation” against PKI units in Solo to give the government a chance to move on PKI armed units.®
79 Berita Indonesia, September 13,1948, p. 1; M erdeka, September 13,1948, p. 1. 80 Anderson, Java, pp. 262-63, describes Muwardi’s relations with Sukarno; also see Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 266-67. The usual lineup in Solo was Barisan Banteng and Hizbullah against the Pesindo. One o f Muwardi’s chief aides in the Barisan Banteng was Muljadi Djojomartono, a Solo Muhammadiyah leader who had also been in the Hizbullah. Muwardi’s other top aide, Sudiro, had close links to the PNI. (Conversation with Pro fessor Benedict Anderson.) Some Siliwangi troops were apparently stationed in or at Barisan Banteng head quarters. A lso see M erdeka, October 7,1948, p. 4, for close Siliwangi-Tan Malaka relations. 81 Berita Indonesia, August 3,1948, p. 3, August 5,1948, p. 1; M erdeka, August 5,1948, p. 1; H arian Indonesia, August 3,1948, p. 3. This was all the more surprising as four days earlier on August 1, a GRR meeting had issued its usual anti-Hatta, anti-Renville statements. 82 P olice Report, August 20,1948, pp. 83-87. 83 M erdeka, September 3, 1948, p. 1; Facta dan D ocu m en t pt. 7, p. 70: the PKI in 1951 charged that Dr. Muwardi had also met with Sukarno on August 5 for a discussion o f the FDR and had at that time been given three million rupiah (which had come from the US government) to cause incidents which would give the Hatta government the opportunity to move against the FD R and destroy them. (BintangM erah, August/Septem ber 1948, p. 42.)
67 Until the PKI reorganization announcement of August 31, the GRR evidently had felt that there was some possibility that Musso might join with them rather than with the PKI. Musso had even met with GRR youth leader Ibnu Parna and others from Akoma (Angkatan Komunis Muda—Young Communist Forces) on August 28, to discuss the pos sibility of some sort of merger with the PKI. After the PKI reorganization, however, the GRR gave up these efforts and launched an all-out attack on Musso and the PKI. Rustam Effendi, acting as GRR spokesman, accused PKI leaders Amir and Setiadjit of being henchmen of the Dutch, and GRR spokesmen took to the field calling for Amir to be hung.84 (Amir was to admit that he had accepted money from the Dutch—on PKI orders - to organize an underground against the Japanese.8586) The GRR, like the PKI, then began to hold mass rallies first in Yogyakarta on September 5 (where Rustam Effendi spoke) and then in Solo on September 8.80 At the same time, the GRR’s “illegal” actions were growing, and on September 9 Pesindo headquarters in Solo were attacked, presumably by members of the Barisan Banteng.87 Pesindo promptly called this a political act and appar ently intimated that the attackers (who were never named) were connected with the gov ernment. This was promptly denied by the government, which claimed that neither its troops nor civilian personnel were involved, and threatened to take firm action unless the kidnappings (which were also occurring in Solo at this time) were promptly halted.88 Peristiwa Solo (The Solo Affair) The incidents in Solo provided the spark which was to set off the revolt in Madiun one week later, but the events are so clouded in mystery that it is almost impossible to draw a sharp and detailed picture of what actually happened. The broad outlines, however, are clear. A series of kidnappings and attacks on the Pesindo forces in Solo, which were part of Colonel Suadi’s Division IV, touched off clashes between Suadi’s forces and Siliwangi troops also stationed in the city. A cease-fire was called by Sudirman, but left-wing troops of Suadi’s command, after initially obeying the order, went into revolt again as they feared the government was going to use the Solo incident as an excuse to bring their rebellious Division IV under control. The main problem in describing the Solo incidents is that they were only scantily re ported by the press at the time. Later reports vary greatly, as each side then had a stake in getting its particular version accepted. The official Siliwangi history claims that the Sil iwangi simply stepped in to separate fighting going on between Dr. Muwardi’s forces and Pesindo, and that Pesindo and ALRI units took this opportunity treacherously to attack the Siliwangi.89 The PKI on the other hand, in its official version, claimed that a team of kidnappers, closely connected to both the Hatta government and the Siliwangi command and led by “Alip Hartojo,” started a series of kidnappings on September 1 against PKI officials in Solo. Suadi sent some of his officers to Siliwangi headquarters to investigate
84 Derita, L im a Minggu, p. 8; M erdeka, September 9,1948, p. 1; Berita Indonesia, September 9,1948, p. 1. 85 Berita Indonesia, September 13,1948, p. 1. 86 M erdeka, September 9,1948, p. 1. 87 Berita Indonesia, September 14,1948, p. 1; K engPo, September 15,1948, p. 1, quoting Radio Gelora Pemuda from Solo. 88 M erdeka, September 15,1948, p. 1. 89 Siliwangi dan M asa, p. 240.
68 the incidents and they too disappeared. (The PKI “proved” government connections with these incidents by charging that some of the kidnap victims were later turned over to gov ernment prisons by the Siliwangi command.) According to the PKI account, Suadi then complained to officials (presumably Hatta supporters) in Yogyakarta and got nowhere. General Sudirman when approached, however, gave Suadi permission to bring the situ ation under control. On September 10, Suadi issued an ultimatum to the Siliwangi to re turn his officers. The Siliwangi refused, so on September 13 Suadi attacked, only to pull back when Sudirman ordered a cease-fire. Pesindo and ALRI troops, according to the PKI account, then went on the defensive again when it became clear that the Siliwangi was not going to obey the cease-fire and that the government for some mysterious reason was going to support the Siliwangi offenders.90 To add to the confusion of accounts on Solo, a few days after the Madiun coup George Kahin was given yet another version by Republican friends close to the government: on the 8th of September, a number of PKI military officers from the Fourth Division “disap peared,” and the PKI blamed Alip, an ex-BPRI officer close to the Siliwangi and then liv ing next to Siliwangi headquarters in Solo. PKI ALRI officers went to Alip’s house, and, finding him absent, carried several Siliwangi officers whom they found there back to ALRI headquarters. These men were then retrieved by the Siliwangi. Suadi, who was still suspi cious of the Siliwangi’s involvement in the kidnappings, then issued his ultimatum.91 The problem with both the 1951 PKI account and that given to Kahin directly after the coup is that both largely ignore the GRR, which plainly was involved. It was probably the GRR which attacked Pesindo headquarters on September 9, and Pesindo was to seek its revenge on September 13 by kidnapping and executing Muwardi and several other GRR members. Also, directly after Madiun started, Musso was to claim that Sukarno in Solo had made use of “Trotskyist traitors to terrorize and kidnap all Communists.”92 Involvement of the Siliwangi in the events in Solo during the week of September 13 were clearly more complex than a simple clash between pro- and anti-Communist troops. The clashes had overtones of the deep-seated rivalries between the West and Central Java troops which had been brewing for months. Unlike the Javanese troops, who were of ficered by young Javanese soldiers, usually with simple Indonesian, Dutch, or Japanese education, the Siliwangi was an elite corps drawn mainly from Sunda (West Java) and Sumatra, with generally higher education standards.93 Its officers were often Dutch-edu cated sons of aristocratic West Javanese families, like Achmad Wiranatakusumah (son of the Wali Negara of Pasundan, R A A Wiranatakusumah) and Sentot Iskandardinata (son of Oto Iskandardinata, the well-known Pasundan leader). Unlike the Javanese troops, who tended to be radical nationalist in orientation and abartgan in outlook, the Siliwangi, 90 Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1951, pp. 42-43. The PKI account o f Madiun, published in 1951, was part of a campaign to clear the black mark on the PKI’s name by issuing a revised version o f the coup. The account is impressively “documented” with names and dates in an obvious attempt to give a ring o f authenticity. (See Chapter V .) It is almost impossible to check, without extensive interviews, the names, etc. used in the PKI account of the Solo incident. 91 Kahin notes on interview, 1948. 92 Front N asional, September 20,1948 (PKI paper published in Madiun for one week by the National Front Government). In 1951, the PKI was more friendly with the Tan Malaka forces and this may be one reason their part is played down. It is also charged by some that the Siliwangi sometimes used Barisan Banteng uni forms to attack FDR supporters, but the kidnapping of Dr. Muwardi and other Barisan Banteng leaders on the 13th by the FD R clearly indicates Barisan Banteng involvement in this case. 93 Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 184-85.
69 through its higher-educated leaders, was permeated with Western influences, and it was Islam, rather than the syncretic beliefs of Central Java, which bound the widely diverse Siliwangi troops from Sumatra and West Java together. The pro-US orientation of the Siliwangi was at times pronounced. Achmad Wiranatakusumah’s brigade, for instance, was known (proudly) as the “American Brigade” because its officers preferred to use English, rather than Dutch or Indonesian, among themselves and copied the casual life styles of their American heroes, such as Clark Gable or Errol Flynn.94 When Siliwangi troops were withdrawn from West Java in early 1948 and stationed in and around Solo, incidents immediately started to occur. The usual problems of “foreign troops” (i.e., Moslem Sundanese) stationed in an alien setting (abangan Central Java) were further exacerbated both by the politics of the times and by lack of discipline among the Siliwangi rank and file. The Siliwangi experienced severe difficulties both in housing and supplies when they were pulled back to the Solo area, and some of the troops appar ently had to fend for themselves, being quartered in markets, etc. According to Nasution, conditions were so poor that they “disturbed the health and morality of the troops,”95who seem to have indulged in a bit of robbery and other mischief making which did nothing to endear them to the local population. The Siliwangi too was immediately plunged into the politics surrounding the capital city and Solo. The FDR at first attempted to infiltrate the Siliwangi. The Siliwangi, however, was strongly anti-Amir, and when infiltration tactics failed the FDR turned their efforts to a campaign of vilification aimed at convincing the Solonese that the Siliwangi were pro-Dutch traitors.96 Tensions rose not only between the pro-FDR ALRI and Pesindo troops in Suadi’s Divi sion IV and the Siliwangi, but also between the Siliwangi and other pro-government Java nese troops such as the Tentara Pelajar (TP Student Army) and Bung Tomo’s BPRI. Some of these tensions came to a head in mid-August when a Siliwangi unit raided a gov ernment depot to seize Lebaran (the main Moslem holiday) presents for their families. Infuriated, Tentara Pelajar troops accompanied by ALRI units from Division IV promptly attacked the Siliwangi unit involved, in an effort to punish those undisciplined and uncouth (kurang ajar) acts. Fighting was halted, but the guilty Siliwangi commander, protesting that he had had enough of living in these hostile surroundings, gathered his troops to gether and announced that he was heading back home to West Java where his troops would be welcomed and cared for.97* The fact that the Siliwangi were pro-government and could therefore plainly be used as a government weapon against the Division IV*s attempts to resist rationalization only
94 M adjalah M erdeka, December 4,1948, p. 6. 95 Nasution, TNI, 2; 162. 96 Siliwangi D ari M asa, pp. 238-39, 260-61; M adjalah M erdeka, October 30, 1948, pp. 6-7. M adjalah M erdeka comments that once FD R attempts to infiltrate the Siliwangi failed, the FDR attacked the Siliwangi as “hench men o f the Dutch/* even pointing to the initials on the side o f Siliwangi Jeeps SLW to show that they were Stoottroepen Leger Wilhemina (Wilhemina’s Shock Troops). M adjalah M erdeka commented that the Siliwangi particularly hated Amir and the FDR who, they felt, had surrendered W est Java to the Dutch and betrayed them. Amir as defense minister had reportedly also done a great deal o f maneuvering to bring Siliwangi troops under his control, trying to remove som e o f the officers as “pro-Dutch/* and this too had earned the SiliwangTs enmity. 97 Nasution, TNI, 2: 234; Siliwangi dari M assa, p. 227. In Nasution’s account Siliwangi officer Rukman simply departs for W est Java. In the Siliwangi history, Rukman is ordered to infiltrate back into West Java to avoid further clashes in Solo.
70 heightened tensions between the two units, and a fight had been brewing for weeks. Whether or not the Siliwangi was actually involved in the kidnappings (and it does seem likely), Suadi undoubtedly felt they were responsible, either directly or by their friendship with (hence protection of) the Barisan Banteng.98 The PKI for its part also seems to have suspected that the kidnappings were the start of an effort to break the effectiveness of their troops and bring them under the control of the central government. This impression was heightened when on the 12th and 13th, just a few days after the Division IV officers vanished in Solo, the government evidently began clean-up operations against “disruptive elements” in Blitar and Nganjuk by arresting several PKI party members.99 In any case, Suadi, who had long wanted an opportunity to discipline the unruly Siliwangi outsiders, was able to get Sudirman’s permission to bring the kidnappings under control. (Sudirman throughout seemed sympathetic to Suadi’s dilemma in trying to maintain peace in Solo, and if the kidnappings were government sponsored, Sudirman at least was not involved.100) Once Suadi issued his ultimatum on Friday, September 11, to the local commander of the Siliwangi, Colonel Sadikin, events were on a collision course. Sadikin, denying any responsibility for the kidnappings even when questioned by Sudirman, had no intention of yielding to Suadi, and Suadi was probably aching to discipline the hated Siliwangi.101 When Suadi’s ultimatum expired sometime after noon on Monday, September 13, Suadi, using ALRI troops from his command, attacked, and immediately Division IV and various Siliwangi units were mixed up in a confusing fire-fight which swirled around Siliwangi headquarters in Srambatan.102 At 6:00 that evening, Sudirman, arriving in Solo, arranged a cease-fire, ordered all troops to barracks, and called on the elite (pro-government) police “mobile brigade” to take over the maintenance of city security.103 For the next two days an uneasy truce seems to have reigned. In the midst of the fighting on Monday morning, however, Pesindo troops had kidnapped Dr. Muwardi and several other GRR leaders, probably in retribution for the earlier kidnappings of the PKI officers, and tempers on all sides were now too heated to be restrained for long.104
98 The PKI was later to charge that an attack was made on Pesindo headquarters on September 16 by Siliwangi troops dressed in Barisan Banteng uniforms (Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 43). This, of course, is possible although the Barisan Banteng was quite capable of doing the deed themselves. 99 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 288; Berita Indonesia, September 15,1948. 100 When the fighting first broke out in Solo between the Siliwangi and Division IV, Sudirman first proposed to send the troublesome Siliwangi unit to the front lines to get them out of Solo. He evidently felt strongly that this, rather than punishment of the IVth, was the way to solve the Solo security problem. He was dis suaded by Nasution, who warned that the Siliwangi would feel that they were being unjustly punished and, like Rukman, they would become uncontrollable and simply leave for home, causing all sorts o f international prob lems with the Dutch and Renville. (Nasution, o f course, wanted the Siliwangi to remain in Solo precisely as a weapon against the IVth.) Nasution was backed up in his argument by Colonel Sadikin who asked Sudirman “are my actions since PON considered as a revolt or in defense o f my country? If they are considered as a rebellion then I don’t care any more and will go home to West Java.” (See Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 176, quoting an unpublished work of Nasution.) 101 Ibid., pp. 119,175. 102 The Siliwangi claims that Division IV treacherously attacked them (Major Achmad Wiranatakusuma’s bat talion) at 10:00 in the morning, four hours before Suadi’s 2:00 p.m. deadline (Siliwangi dan M asa, p. 234). 103 M erdeka, September 16,1948, p. 1; Berita Indonesia, September 16,1948, p. 1; and Nasution, 77V7, 2: 234. Sedjarah Diponegoro, p. 179, however, says that the quarrel was settled by the attorney general who was called in to mediate, and that CPM (Military Police) units were used as well as regular police forces to control the city (o f course both Sudirman and the attorney general may have been present). 104 M erdeka, September 15,1948, p. 1; and M urba, September 15,1948.
71 Exactly what happened during the two crucial days (Tuesday and Wednesday, the 14th and 15th) that follow is again unclear. Apparently, some Siliwangi units, which should have stayed in their barracks outside the city, came in to reinforce their fellows, and this both infuriated and frightened the Pesindo and ALRI units in Division IV.105 By the eve ning of Wednesday, September 15, fighting had flared again, as more kidnappings (by the GRR?) took place again in front of Pesindo headquarters.106 Fighting lasted through the night, and from this point on things went from bad to worse as the Pesindo and ALRI troops apparently made the decision to commit themselves to battle, and the government for its part moved to end the problem of the renegade IVth once and for all. According to Nasution, on Wednesday evening, after the fighting had resumed, Sudirman again took to the air, appealing to his troops to remain neutral and warning that the government and army had decided to take harsh steps to bring the Solo situation under control.107 By Sep tember 16, Thursday, it was apparent that the fighting was totally out of control, and Sudir man called a meeting with the head of the Military Police Corps (CPM), Gatot Subroto, and Nasution. Deciding that the time for compromise was well past, the three met that evening with President Sukarno, to convince him that strong measures had to be taken against Suadi’s troops and to suggest that Gatot Subroto be named military governor of Solo with full powers (e.g. command over the Siliwangi) to normalize the situation.108 On Friday, September 17, the announcement was made that Solo was considered to be in a “dangerous situation” and that Gatot Subroto had taken over as military governor.109 By Friday, however, Suadi’s troops (at least the battalions involved, i.e., the Pesindo and ALRI units) had been expelled from Solo by Sadikin’s forces, who seem to have been al lowed to attack when the fighting flared again.110* Subroto, a man of action, immediately
105 Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1948, p. 43. 106 Persatoean, September 17,1948, p. 1, quoting Antara; Benia Indonesia, September 17, 1948, p. 1, quoting A ntara report September 16. Bintang Merah in 1951 (p. 43) and Kahin, N ationalism , p. 289, place this attack on Pesindo headquarters on the 16th. However, Bintang Merah agrees that fighting broke out again on the evening o f the 15th when Division IV, Pesindo, and ALRI troops, deciding that the Siliwangi would not obey the truce, attacked. 107 Berita Indonesia, September 16,1948; N asional, September 16,1948. According to the PKI accounts, fight ing commenced again at 6:00 p.m. (Bintang M erah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 43). Sudirman’s speech was given in the evening, presumably after the start o f the renewed fighting. 108 Nasution, 72V/, 2: 237. 109 Ibid., p. 238. The decision to appoint Gatot Subroto military governor was made and orders issued on Thursday, September 16, according to the Sedjarah TNI Diponegoro, p. 180. Conceivably the announcement could also have been made on the 16th, but indications from press reports are that, as Nasution states, it was not made until Friday, September 17. Berita Indonesia, September 18,1948, says that Gatot Subroto himself made the announcement that Solo was in “keadaan bahaja.” The account given in this thesis contrasts with that o f Kahin in N ationalism , p. 289, which says that Sukarno proclaimed martial law for Solo and appointed Subroto military governor on Wednesday, September 15. 110 Only the PKI (ALRI and Pesindo) units o f Suadi’s command actually went into rebellion (although this was the majority o f his troops). One unit under Slamet Rijadi early in the week refused to aid Suadi against the Siliwangi. (Kahin notes confirmed by Voice o f Free Indonesia, September 25,1948, and accounts in Sedjarah Diponegoro, pp. 182,203.) (Rijadi, a Sudirman man, was commanding Suadi’s old Battalion V .) Suadi himself later appears to have surrendered the units under his direct control to Sudirman. (See M erdeka, October 7, 1948, p. 1, for an account o f Suadi’s surrender.) It is difficult to tell exactly when this took place because Suadi, proud and adamant in his dislike o f the Siliwangi, refused to surrender to Gatot Subroto, “who was no better a commander than I was.” Suadi had never held more than nominal control over the loyalties o f the FDR troops in his division, especially the two ALRI battalions; Battalion VII under Lieutenant Colonel Jadau, 25 years old, and Battalion IX under Suadi’s former chief o f staff, Lieutenant Colonel Sujoto. These FD R troops in turn were suspicious o f Suadi and appear to have turned on Suadi’s troops when he was procrastinating over
72 took charge and, arriving in Solo on the 18th, ordered the fighting to stop and called for all commanders to surrender by Tuesday, September 21, or be considered rebels. By Sunday, all was quiet in Solo, and Subrotö was busily getting youth groups together in peace meet ings.111 By this time, however, the action had moved elsewhere. The Solo events were not taking place in a vacuum. Just as they were being anxiously observed by the government forces in Yogyakarta, so, too, were they being studied by hot headed young Pesindo commanders in Madiun and by the touring campaigners under Musso. Communications on Java were difficult but they were not impossible, and while Musso was out of effective command range he was apparently aware of what was going on. According to BintangM erah, Musso even sent a message from Cepu to Solo on Thursday, September 16 (when affairs were already well out of hand), asking that the incidents in Solo not be allowed to spread to other areas.112 It is very difficult to tell exactly what Musso’s role was in the events that followed. PKI military commanders only two hours away in Madiun, however, were completely informed of the turn of events in Solo and were increasingly alarmed by these events, which they saw as the beginning of a govern ment drive against the PKI.113 It would have seemed normal for them to contact Musso to consult him on their actions, but as Musso was apparently caught unawares in Purwodadi when the actual coup in Madiun took place, it seems that at least in this event he was not informed. Disregarding Musso’s appeal to localize the Solo incident, if indeed it was made, PKI commanders under the control of radical Pesindo leader Sumarsono, on about Thursday, September 16, started to pull their troops back from the front against the Dutch and rede ploy them around Madiun. Some troops may also have been sent forward toward Solo to reinforce PKI, ALRI, and Pesindo troops there who had just been ousted from the city.114 whether or not to surrender to Gatot Subroto. (See Sedjarah TN IDiponegoro, pp. 176,178,182,203, for com position of Suadi’s troops.) 111 Berita Indonesia, September 21,1948, p. 2. 112 BintangM erah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 43. 113 From the moment the revolt began, PKI leaders were to stress that their actions were in response to those of the government in Solo. According to M erdeka, Radio Gelora Pemuda, broadcasting from Madiun on Sep tember 18 at 7:30 p.m., charged that the Hatta government was working with the Dutch to keep Indonesia a colony, and at 8:10 p.m. they stated that they feared the government had become fascist and was plotting with the Dutch to destroy the left wing. (M erdeka, September 21,1948, p. 4.) In a radio broadcast on September 21, from Madiun, Suripno charged that the government had taken no steps in Solo to control the lawless acts o f the “Siliwangi, Banteng, and Masjumi, etc.” and that seeing this, the “citizens of Madiun acted for their own safety.” “The activity to abolish communism has been long in prepara tion,” he said. (Front N asional, September 22,1948.) A lso see Suripno’s “Tulisan dari Pendjara” in Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 86, where Suripno says his friends in Madiun saw Solo as the beginning o f an anti-FDR campaign. Front N asional, on September 21,1948, also charged that Solo was the beginning o f an offensive against the Communists and indeed the government in Madiun had “organized military and police forces to enact general suppressions supposedly to begin on the 19th of September 1948.” 114 Gadis Rasid, who accompanied the troops into the Madiun area for the PSI newspaper Siasat, reported that from the 16th, FDR forces had moved in to take control o f areas on the outskirts o f Madiun (Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 178, quoting Siasat, September 26,1948.) The GRR newspaper M urba reported that this move began on September 12, but M urba is hardly a reliable source. Its report was supposedly a delayed one from Madiun and it appeared on September 21 in Antara. (Berita Indonesia, September 22,1948, p. 3.) Kahin (N ationalism , p. 290, drawing on M urba), says the troop movements started on September 13. There seem s to be some question whether PKI troops were actually pulled back from the front, which was, o f course, not that far from Madiun in any case. According to the Siliwangi history (Siliwangi dari M assa, pp. 238, 241),
73 It is, of course, hard to tell at this point whether these movements were simply “preventa tive” against the possibility of an all-out attack by the Siliwangi against the PKI, or whether some plan for the takeover of Madiun as a base for revolution was already in their minds. (Until the appointment of Gatot Subroto on the 17th, with the accompanying indications that the government intended to take very firm steps, the PKI may have still hoped that they could talk their way out of further action.) In any case, the announcement on Friday seems to have precipitated events, and Sumarsono, backed up by Pesindo units from Bri gade 29 under Colonel Dachlan, started making preparations for action early the next morning. Madiun The government of the Republic of Indonesia has issued an official announcement concerning the events in the City of Madioen, East Java, yesterday September 18. This announcement is as follows: Under the auspices and leadership of the former Peoples Democratic Front now in the process of amalgamation into the Indonesian Communist Party, the PKI, and through the use of the units of the Republican Army in East Java, an assault was made on the government organs of the Republic in the City of Madioen on September 18, 1948, and a change has been ef fected in the regional administration there is an illegal way of using armed forces [sic]. The government of the Republic of Indonesia is now taking steps by all means at its command to restore the legal authority and administra tion in the area involved. The entire population is asked to give its fullest support for the sake of the well-being of the Republic of Indonesia. Dated Jogjakarta, September 19,1948. Voice of Free Indonesia broadcasting from Jogjakarta in English to Australia and East Asia, 5:00 p.m., September 19,1948.115 When Sumarsono’s units decided to move in Madiun, they did so quickly and effec tively. According to the official PKI account, at one o’clock in the morning of Saturday, September 18, PKI troops of Brigade 29 under Colonel Dachlan moved into the city and quickly put down the minimal resistance they met from the Siliwangi and Police Mobile Brigade units stationed in the city. Police and Siliwangi officers were captured and put in detention. By 8:00, the fighting was over and the city was in Sumarsono’s hands.116 At 10:00 in the morning, Sumarsono took to the air on Radio Gelora Pemuda to announce
Colonel Dachlan’s Brigade 29 (a former TNI Masyarakat unit composed mostly of Pesindo troops now in Sungkono’s Division VI) was composed o f six battalions stationed around the Madiun area. These had been ordered to the front after Baay*s ultimatum. However, according to Siliwangi dari M asa, they moved instead to Madiun. 115 FBIS, September 20,1948. 116 BintangM erah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 45; Nasution, 77V/, 2: 238, says the chief of staff of the East Java Command, his officers, and the commandant of the CPM were either arrested or killed.
74 that the people had taken over the government and were establishing a “National Front Government for the Region of Madiun.”117 Later that afternoon (at 5:30 p.m.) a state ment was issued that the Communist vice mayor of Madiun would take over the regional government, both military and civilian.118 The top civilian leadership of the PKI seems to have been taken completely off guard by Sumarsono’s coup. Word reached Purwodadi sometime Saturday morning, and, ac companied by Amir, Setiadjit, Djokosujono, and Wikana, Musso set out immediately for Madiun, arriving there sometime before midnight.119 Other PKI leaders, such as Alimin, Aidit, Lukman, and Tan Ling Djie were caught in Yogyakarta apparently unaware of events in Madiun. Suripno made it through to Madiun only because he was due to speak there and had taken a train from Yogyakarta to Madiun Saturday morning.120 Amir’s wife and children as well as, one presumes, the families of the rest of the PKI leadership were still in Yogyakarta.121 The PKI leadership was probably none too pleased with this sudden turn of events. If they had been planning a coup, it was certainly not for this moment when their forces were still unconsolidated and their plan of battle unformulated.122 While undoubtedly there was a great deal of discussion of what should be done once the PKI leaders reached Madiun, no concrete move seems to have been made. The PKI has claimed that it sent cables ei ther on Saturday or Sunday informing the government of its actions to protect the “secu rity” of the city and requesting “instructions” on what it should do next.123 It is quite pos117 Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 80. 118 Front N asional, September 20,1948. 119 Dimyati, Sedjarah, p. 181. Musso’s trip to Madiun took longer than one would have expected, but this was probably due to detours around government-held areas. 120 Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 86, from “Tulisan Suripno dalem Pendjara Sala.” 121 M adjalah Merdeka, October 9,1948, p. 3. There is no rhyme or reason as to which PKI leaders were where at the time o f the coup. Alimin, who disapproved of the coup, was stranded in Yogyakarta, as was Aidit who was generally a Musso supporter. Prisoners captured in Yogyakarta said they knew nothing of a plan to seize power and thought Musso’s actions a “bit hasty (agak terburu)” according to M erdeka, September 30,1948. 122 H idup, December 18,1948, p. 3; Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 86. Both Amir and Suripno later pointed out that, even if there had been a plan for a coup, it was definitely not for this time when the PKI was still undergoing massive reorganization. 123 D . N. Aidit, A id it Accuses the M adiun A ffair (Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1955), p. 25; Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 86; Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber, p. 47. The PKI was later to claim that this takeover was only intended to calm the local situation, which had grown very tense because of Solo and of an incident earlier in the week where a government employee (a member o f one o f the SOBSI unions) had been beaten by the Madiun police. Aidit pointed out that the Resi dent o f Madiun was in Yogyakarta, the Deputy Resident Sidharto was unable to control the situation, and the mayor was sick. Thus, PKI Deputy Mayor Supardi had to take over. The minute Supardi had things under control, Aidit claims, he promptly sent a cable to the central government in Yogyakarta requesting instructions on what should be done next. (Aidit, A id it Accuses, p. 25.) The only problem with this tale is that Sumarsono plainly took control o f Madiun to protect his troops from what he thought was a government drive which threatened to crush the PKI. The committee set up to run Madiun as published in Front N asional, September 20,1948, is almost entirely composed of PKI members, and it seems very unlikely this would have been the case if the takeover had only been seen as a temporaiy measure. Unfortunately, a copy of Sumarsono’s radio address is not available, and there is no way of telling how harsh it was. Sumarsono was a fiery radical who had led the pem uda against the British in Surabaya and who had also been convinced since at least June or July that the government intended to take over the PKI military forces. It is doubtful that any message was sent to the Hatta government asking for further instructions. If it had been, it is hardly likely the government would have taken it seriously, especially since at the time Radio
75 sible, of course, that some attempt at mediation may have been made. (Colonel Suharto, at that time a member of the Yogyakarta command, was later to be sent to Madiun to negotiate, but this does not seem to have occurred until early the following week.124) Basi cally, on Saturday evening and through the day on Sunday, the PKI leaders in Madiun seem to have taken a wait-and-see position. No announcements were apparently made, but the PKI was plainly unwilling to relinquish its control of the city immediately. If the PKI was waiting to see what the government would do, they got their answer at 8:00 p.m. on Sunday. Speaking in a radio address which was as dramatic as only Sukarno could make it, the Indonesian president told his people that the government considered the “incidents” at Solo and Madiun just the preliminary steps in the traitorous plan by the “PKI-Musso” to overthrow the legal government of the Republic of Indonesia (see Ap pendix B). “Yesterday morning the Communist Party of Musso staged a coup in Madiun, and formed a Soviet government there under the leadership of Musso. They consider this seizure of power by force as a preliminary step in the seizure of the entire government of the Republic of Indonesia.” Sukarno went on to give two choices to his people: follow Musso and his PKI or follow Sukarno and Hatta. The die was now cast as far as Musso was concerned. At 11:30, Musso gave his only possible reply: Sukarno and H atta are slaves of the Japanese and Americans and traitors to the Indonesian people, “therefore the happenings in Madiun and elsewhere are a signal to the whole people to wrest the powers of the State into their own hands.” (See Appendix C for text of speech.) While the H atta government’s reply to the coup was firm, like the PKI leaders they too seem to have been taken off guard by the sudden move in Madiun. Sudirman, apparently thinking that Subroto and the Siliwangi had Solo under control, had returned to Magelang to explain to military leaders there what was happening in Solo.125 Nasution first heard of Sumarsono’s takeover of Madiun on Saturday (afternoon?) from PNI leader Ali Sastroamidjojo, who called him to a cabinet meeting with Sukarno. After the events in Solo and now in Madiun, Hatta and the Masyumi leaders were undoubtedly convinced that a clash with Musso’s radical PKI was inevitable and that it was better to fight now than later when the PKI might be even stronger. However, the cabinet which met until late into Saturday evening came up only with a vague decision to give Sudirman authority to take the necessary steps “to safeguard the Republic.” Nasution was then given the task of
Gelora Pemuda from Madiun was calling the government fascist collaborators with the Dutch and saying that Madiun had been set up to destroy all “the enem ies o f the people.” (Soe Hok Gie, “Simpang Kiri,” p. 178, quoting Radio Gelora Pemuda.) 124 Events surrounding Suharto’s trip are rather confused. O. G. Roeder in The Sm iling G eneral (Jakarta: Gunung Agung, 1970), p. 113, says Suharto went to Madiun before the coup. This seem s unlikely as the gov ernment was focused on Solo at this point. Nasution says Suharto helped him to round up PKI supporters in Yogyakarta on Sunday, September 19 (Nasution, TNI, 2: 239). Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1951, p. 48, has Suharto being sent to Madiun on Tuesday, September 21 by the government to observe what was occur ring. According to Bintang M erah, Suharto returned to Yogyakarta with a letter from Musso calling for a halt to the fighting, a National Front government, and the implementation of the National Program. Suripno in Tulisan (Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 88) just after the coup also mentions Suharto’s visit but says the letter was from Sumarsono proposing that “we stop the civil war and together face the Dutch imperialist aggres sion.” In any case, there does seem to have been some unsuccessful attempt to negotiate in which Suharto participated. H e evidently was accompanied by PKI representative Wikana on this mission. The PKI terms, as laid out by Bintang Merah, gave little indication the PKI was willing to compromise with the government. 125 Nasution, TNI, 2: 238.
76 implementing the orders and set out to prepare his troops for a sweep against PKI organi zations in Yogyakarta at 7:00 on Sunday morning.126 The sweep was carried out with ruthless efficiency. All the PKI presses were seized, Pesindo and SOBSI shut down, and something over 400 PKI leaders taken into custody. The government itself, however, does not seem to have moved to announce the coup in Madiun until sometime in the afternoon of Sunday, and it was, of course, not until evening that Sukarno and other government leaders, Hatta, the Sultan, and Sudirman, made their radio broadcasts. Guy Pauker feels that Sukarno was hesitant to denounce the Commu nists,127and it is, of course, possible that Sukarno and the PNI, and perhaps even Sudirman (who seems to have been ill at the time according to Nasution),128 were attempting to re strain the more right-wing forces in the government in hopes the PKI might make some conciliatory move. Whatever the case, Sukarno’s speech and Musso’s reply left little room for compro mise. The PKI seems to have gone eagerly into battle, at least for the first few days, and the government’s response was equally determined. On Sunday, Gatot Subroto was ap pointed military commander for Central Java and Sungkono for East Java, both with or ders to suppress the revolt,129 and on Monday, the Masyumi leapt happily into the breach calling for a holy war against the PKI.130 The PKI, for its part, in an obvious attempt to gain a wider base of support, announced that its action was no coup but a “correction” of the Republic’s government and that Sukarno was lying when he called the government in Madiun a “Soviet.” The Communists, Suripno said on Monday, September 20, had no in-
126 Ibid., p. 238. 127 Guy Pauker, The R ise an d F all o f the Comm unist Party o f Indonesia (Santa Monica, CA: Rand Corporation, 1969), p. 15. 128 Nasution, TNI, 2:239. 129 Berita Indonesia, September 20,1948, p. 1. Sungkono may have been named commander of East Java in an attempt by the central government to win his allegiance. 130 Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 106. On September 20, according to Pinardi, Masyumi head Sukiman called for a holy war against the Communists. On September 23, Minister of Religion Kiayi Haji Maskoer in a large Islamic meeting announced that the Musso coup was against religion. (Berita Indonesia, September 25,1948, p. 1.) The Masyumi defense council promptly ordered the Hizbullah and Sabilillah into action to arrest and disarm the PKI (H idup, September 21,1948; Guntur, September 21,1948). Masyumi members were later told that, if in their areas “government officials are unable to take steps [against the PKI] or are hesitating, then Masyumi members should act firmly.” (Berita Indonesia, October 6,1948, p. 1.) The thought o f the Moslems taking independent action horrified non-Moslems, and within a few days the PSI was loudly demanding that only official government troops be used against the PKI. (N asional, Septem ber 21,1948; Sikap K im , September 25,1948. While the PKI ‘Terror” of the time was well reported in the press, Masyumi counter-terror was not, al though the existence o f this “terror and counter-terror” as he termed it, was admitted by Hatta in a radio broadcast on November 17 (Berita Indonesia, November 17,1948, p. 1). It appears that some indiscriminate anti-abangan killing may have taken place, although most seems to have taken the form o f rounding up PKI leaders, giving them a summary trial, and executing them. See D e VrijePers (Decem ber 29,1948) for pictures of PKI prisoners being tried by military courts, apparently after torture, led off to graves, and shot. (D e Vrije Pers was, o f course, a Dutch organ and this was part of Dutch anti-Republic propaganda from Surabaya.) Most PKI members, however, were simply imprisoned. Killings on the scale o f 1965 do not seem to have taken place on either side, perhaps because Madiun did, on the whole, remain a confrontation between opposing troops rather than the civilian populations.
77 tention of setting up a completely Communist government like a “Soviet.” Theirs was a “National Front.”131 The Fall The end of the “National Front Government” came quickly. Exactly thirteen days after Sumarsono’s troops first seized Madiun, government troops under Gatot Subroto rolled into the city. The PKI, in taking their stand against the Hatta government, seem to have counted on two things: the support of the bulk of the troops in Sungkono’s command,132 and the support of the people in East and East Central Java if the Communist troops were forced out of Madiun into guerrilla warfare in the countryside. They got neither. The PKI assumed they had the support of most of the troops in Suadi’s Division IV but, after the defection of both Slamet Rijadi and Suadi, they were left with only the two scat tered and mauled battalions of ALRI troops under Jadau and Sujoto and a scattering of other Division IV Pesindo units. In East Java, the PKI could count on the irregular troops in the former TNI-Masyaraket (Pesindo) unit of Brigade 29 and a scattering of other exTNI Masyarakat troops from Sungkono’s command.133 The bulk of Sungkono’s troops,
131 M erdeka, September 22,1948, p. 1; and Berita Indonesia, September 21,1948, p. 2. On September 20, the PKI military commander o f Madiun, Djokosujono, also made a similar speech (Radio Gelora Pemuda, Sep tember 20, 1948) saying the “revolt” in Madiun is not “a coup” but a “correction to the policy of those ele ments which wish to bring the Revolution to another direction.” From the very beginning, however, while stressing that theirs was a National Front Government (PKI led, o f course) the PKI did not soften their invec tive against the Hatta/Sukam o government. On September 21, Front N asional, commenting on the “soviet” versus “National Front” problem, called Sukarno the “Chiang Kai Shek of Indonesia,” and in another report called Sukarno and Hatta “reactionaries” who were using the “reactionary army” to attack “revolutionary troops.” On September 27, Front Nasional*s last day, the paper was still referring to the “neo-fascism of Sukamo-Hatta.” On the question of “soviets,” it is entirely possible that Sumarsono, carried away with enthusiasm, used the word “soviet” in his broadcasts on Saturday, September 18. Unfortunately, no copy o f his speech is available. It is just as likely, however, that Sukarno simply made use o f the word for the occasion. The question has caused a tempest in a teapot among PKI writers ever since. While the difference between “soviets” and “Na tional Front Governments” is undoubtedly important to Communist theoreticians, the semantic difference was lost on the Hatta government, which saw the new administration in Madiun for what it was, a Communist-controlled regime. (See Bintang M erah, August/Septem ber 1951, pp. 47-48; Front N asional, September 20,1948, and September 22,1948, for PKI concern on this question.) 132 Djokosujono, former head o f the TNI Masyarakat who was named commander of the PKI troops at Madiun, issued a call on September 22 for all East Java commanders to come to a meeting with him on Sep tember 24, undoubtedly hoping they would give their support to the rebellion (Berita Indonesia, Thursday, September 23,1948, p. 1). Nasution, in an article in Merah Putih on November 27,1948, p. 4, claimed that the PKI plans discovered by the TNI said that the PKI expected to control at least 25 percent o f the army and to neutralize another 30-50 percent. 133 Actual PKI Forces at Madiun consisted of: 1. Brigade 29 o f Colonel Dachlan with six battalions in the Madiun area: Battalion Mustafa from Madiun, Battalion Mursid from Saradan, Battalion Darmintodaji in Ngawi, Battalion Panjang Jokopriono in Ponorogo, Battalion Abdulrachman and others from Kediri, Battalion Jusuf in Ponorogo and Sumoroto (battalions are identified by the names o f their commanders). 2. ALRI and Pesindo units from Division IV under the command of Lieutenant Colonel Jadau and Lieu tenant Colonel Sujoto which remained in the Solo area, plus Brigade 4 o f Division IV from Kedu (three battal ions). 3. Brigade 13 from Division VI-Sungkono (with five battalions) and one battalion o f Brigade 4. These again were ex-TNI Masyarakat troops in the Blitar area which included both Pesindo and BPRI troops.
78 however, after some initial hesitation which must have had the Hatta government on the edge of their seats, came down uneasily on the government’s side.134 On the other hand, the PKI was now faced with the elite, well-trained Siliwangi battalions who were spoiling for a chance to get back at the PKI units which they felt had made their lives so miserable in Solo.135 Also, while Sungkono was procrastinating on the PKPs eastern flank, Police Mobile Brigade troops were not. Furious over the arrest of his police commissioner at Mobrig headquarters in Madiun, peppery Mobrig commander Mohammad Jasin set out immediately from his headquarters in Blitar to launch what may have been the first attack against the PKI Madiun forces.136 With only about 5-10,000 troops at their command, the PKI in their attempt to defend Madiun were easily defeated by the Siliwangi and East Java troops which swept down upon them from three directions.137 Musso and Amir, realizing they could not defend Madiun against Subroto, withdrew their troops from Madiun without firing a shot, and pulled back into the hills for what they hoped would be successful guerrilla warfare. (The PKI had little choice at this point, for Subroto, infuriated by Communist executions of Masyumi and PNI civilian leaders which had occurred in the face of the Siliwangi advance, was calling for unconditional surrender and no quarter to the Communists.138) Amir had apparently counted on access to stores of arms in the hills for guerrilla action against the Dutch (there was one such supply point at Dungus), but the rapid Siliwangi advance cut him off from these.139* (See Sitiwangi dariM asa, p. 241; M erdeka, October 7,1948, p. 4.) No one source seem s totally clear on the composition of the PKI troops which, in addition to the usual PK I/FD R troops, included units from Bung Tom o’s BPRI and at one point a Siliwangi unit in Cepu which, however, quickly changed sides. The govern ment announced that the PKI had 3-4,000 well-arm ed troops in Madiun, but this estimate might be low. (Ber ka Indonesia,, September 23,1948, p. 1.) 134 Berka Indonesia, September 23,1948, p. 1. East Java forces do not seem to have pursued their task with the same enthusiasm as the Siliwangi. Sungkono’s forces did, however, get to Madiun eventually, prompting Simatupang to compare the meeting between the Siliwangi and the East Java troops in Madiun to the Americans and Russians meeting in Berlin [sic] in 1945. (Simatupang, Laporan, p. 98.) A lso see Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 137, for an account of Sungkono’s waverings. 135 M adjalah M erdeka, October 2, 1948, p. 5. The Siliwangi apparently went forward to the attack carrying signs reading “Up to Moscow” in English to show to observers their intention of attacking the “Moscow-con trolled” PKI forces in Madiun. 136 Berka Indonesia, September 23,1948, p. 1. A lso see Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, pp. 31-37, fora full account of Jasin’s exploits. Jasin, much to his chagrin, according to Pinardi, was halted outside of Madiun and was unable to reach Madiun before the Siliwangi troops. The Police Mobile Brigade, like the Siliwangi, was a small but elite force loyal to the Hatta government (as were most of the police forces) (Kahin, N ationalism , p. 185; and M. Oudang, Perkembangan Kepolisian d i Indonesia (Jakarta: Mahabharata, 1952), p. 97). 137 Dimyati, Sedjarah, pp. 184-89, has the clearest account of the attack on Madiun which was launched, via the main road from Solo and via the Sarangan-Gunung Lawu Complex, by two units of the Siliwangi, and from Kediri by East Java troops under Colonel Surachman. A lso see Siliwangi dari M asa, pp. 259-66. 138 Berka Indonesia, October 1,1948, p. 1; Berka Yudha, October 1966. Siliwangi troops encountered their first PKI atrocities in Gorang Gareng outside Dungus near Madiun. PKI troops machine-gunned their prisoners, mostly Masyumi and PNI leaders, in their cells before retreating (see Gadis Rasid’s eyewitness account re printed in Berka Yudha), This and other incidents incensed the Siliwangi and set the stage for Gatot Subroto’s radio statement of September 30, after he entered Madiun that for “cowards who shoot from behind, don’t give mercy, just kill them. They must be treated like Dutch terrorists, because many o f our fellow soldiers have been killed by these attacks from behind; they aren’t brave enough to act openly.” (Berka Indonesia, October 1,1948, p. 1.) 139 Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 127, says Amir as minister of defense may have helped the TNI to store arms in secret places for the TNI Masyarakat to use in case of a Dutch attack. While later accounts imply that Amir
79 In Musso’s first reply to Sukarno and in PKI (National Front Government) broadcasts thereafter, the PKI had repeatedly called for armed risings of the people against the Sukarno-Hatta government. This did occur in a few towns of East Java, where the PKI was traditionally strong (Purwodadi, Cepu, Bojonegoro), and others seems to have passed back and forth between local government and PKI forces.140 But in most areas, the gov ernment moved quickly and effectively, as it had done in Yogyakarta, to neutralize pos sible PKI support. This was particularly the case in Kediri and Blitar in East Java, and Banten in West Java.141 In Sumatra, where the PKI was in any case not very strong, the FDR completely disassociated itself from Madiun.142 In general, in the week that fol lowed, the Madiun coup produced, in government-controlled areas, a mad scramble by various organizations to oust the Communists from their midst and declare their loyalty to the government.143 This was obviously not due simply to the government’s military control of these areas. Most Indonesians, even those who were sympathetic to the PKI, agreed with the government that the Madiun revolt was a treacherous stab in the back at a time when the Republic was facing the possibility of renewed Dutch attacks. Once they committed themselves to fight, the PKI, and especially Amir, seem to have assumed that, if they were evicted from Madiun, they would be able to carry on guerrilla warfare among the people and gain support and momentum as they fought. However, while peasants and workers in some parts of East Java gave initial support to the PKI, they quickly became disillusioned. They had been won by PKI promises of land and labor re form and by charges that the Hatta government was selling the country to the Dutch. Moslem segments of the population were, of course, opposed to the revolt from the begin ning, and the PKI’s main base of support for guerrilla warfare was among the abangan
him self had stashed many such stores o f weapons, the cache at Dungus seem s to have been the only one dis covered at the time. A s weapons were in extremely high demand, it would seem more likely that any weapons Amir could get were immediately distributed to FD R forces. Sutomo, in Sesudah M adiun, p. 12, says he had been ordered by Sudirman and the army command to pre pare a guerrilla base in the Gunung Lawu Complex (i.e., in the Dungus area), which he did with the help of Colonel Holan Iskandar. Sutomo adds that Amir had difficulty using this area for guerrilla activities because the people had been taught (by Bung Tom o) to respect the Hatta government (p. 14). Thus, it would appear that the arms cache, if there were any, were known to both Amir and Sudirman. 140 M erdeka, October 7, 1948, pp. 1, 4; M adjaiah M erdeka, October 23, 1948, p. 5. The oil town of Cepu was partially taken over by units of armed workers, as was Bojonegoro; Purwodadi, another PKI stronghold, wa vered back and forth before being taken on September 25 by an FDR leader, S. Kamo, who seem s to have had dreams o f becoming a “Ratu A dil.” He lasted until October 8 (M adjaiah Merdeka, October 23). 141 Berita Indonesia, September 24,1948, p. 2: immediately after the news from Madiun was received, the com mander o f the TNI in Banten was replaced by Erie Sudewo who was known to be loyal to Sukarno. Sudewo promptly moved to arrest pro-Amir elem ents in the TNI Masyarakat and Bambu Runcing who evidently were about to cause trouble. Sudewo then met with Banten leaders, especially those from the Hizbullah, to see what further measures should be taken to calm the situation. Needless to say, by September 23, Berita Indonesia (p. 1), could an nounce that both the FDR and PKI in Banten were opposed to Musso’s coup. Kediri was Sungkono’s head quarters and Mob rig’s Jasin took care of Blitar. (See Berita Indonesia, September 23,1948, p. 1, on Jasin and M erdeka, September 22,1948, p. 2, for arrests made in Kediri and Blitar on September 20.) 142 Berita Indonesia, September 25,1948, p. 1. The army was well under control in Sumatra where on Septem ber 10 there had been arrests made, not, however, according to a radio broadcast o f September 20 from Bukittinggi, concerning politics (Berita Indonesia, September 22,1948, p. 2). Nasution, however (TN I, 2: 235), im plies that troubles in the West Sumatra command had been tied to the FDR/PK I question. 143 For examples, see M erdeka, September 22,1948, p. 1; September 23,1948, p. 1; September 24,1948, p. 2; September 25,1948, p. 25; September 28, 1948, p. 1.
80 farmers. However, “Pak Tani” also adored Sukarno, and when it became evident that the Siliwangi was not fighting with Dutch support, the peasantry heeded their “father’s” pleas and turned their backs on Amir’s forces. As the Madiun revolt progressed and especially in the face of defeat, undisciplined PKI units turned occasionally in brutal revenge against their hostages and sometimes even against the local population. This did much to lose their movement popularity.144 As Suripno himself was to admit, these “excesses” “greatly isolated us from the sympathy of the people.”145 “Our support,” he said, “was very little and several times indeed the people of the desas [villages] prepared themselves to capture us.”146 The PKI had not even been able to hold Madiun very firmly during their brief tenure there.147 When they moved out into the countryside, they were lost. With no prepared home base, a neutral and unfriendly population, and the government’s troops relentlessly on their heels, they were constantly on the run with their forces melting away each day. The end came on December 1, when Amir and his last group of 300 soldiers were cap tured near the Dutch/Indonesian cease-fire line outside Purwodadi.148 144 It should be kept in mind that killings in theMadiun uprising do not seem to have been extensive on either side. The PKI, however, did strike selectively at Islamic religious leaders, the police, and civil servants (the pam on gpraja). In a list published before all figures were in, the government claimed to have lost 88 officials o f various types including 28 pam ong praja at the bupati level, 15 Ministry o f Information officials, and 25 school teachers. T o this were added 94 police officials and the army’s total o f 44 soldiers killed (159 killed or wounded). (Berita Indonesia, November 5,1948, p. 1; M adjalah M erdeka, October 30,1948, p. 3.) Examples o f PKI brutality were constantly in the press, including bodies in mass graves (56 in one in Tirtomoyo), in wells, boxcars, etc. (See M erdeka, October 20,1948, and M adjalah M erdeka, October 23 and November 6,1948, for examples.) Suripno blamed the killings on bad communications and on the fact that revolutions are usually bloody (Marsudi, Perisüwa M adiun, from Suripno, Tulisan, pp. 88-91). PKI leaders were apparently concerned over the discipline o f their troops; Suripno set up a military court, and during the Madiun days, Front N asional (September 24 and 5,1948) put out long articles talking about the duties of the army to the people according to the examples o f the USSR and China. 145 Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 93, from Suripno, Tulisan. 146 Ibid., p. 93. 147 The PKI seem s never to have had a very firm grip even on Madiun. The military airfield (M asopati) just ten kilometers outside the town was held by government troops which the PKI were unable or unwilling to try to dislodge. (M erdeka, September 24,1948, p. 1.) A lso, the PKI was unable to control fully the non-Communist youth groups in the city who, as the Siliwangi approached, grew constantly bolder. On September 22, the PKI was forced to attack TRIP headquarters to bring these youths under control. In the melee one TRIP student was killed, and the next day his friends held a massive funeral for him which the PKI seems to have been unable to prevent (Siliwangi dan M asa, pp. 25758; Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, pp. 96-97). On the 27th, the new mayor (PKI) o f Madiun, Abdul Mutalip, was booed off the stage when he and Suripno attempted to address a mass meeting o f (hostile) Madiun students to explain the aims of the new regime (M adjalah M erdeka, October 30, 1948, p. 5; also see Pusat Sedjarah, Peranan TN IAngkatan D arat [Bandung: Pussemad, 1965], pp. 140-41; Sin Min, November 10, 1948, gives an ac count o f Mutalib’s trial where he tells of difficulties with students in Madiun). 148 Musso and Amir had parted company earlier and Musso was caught alone and shot by a soldier on October 31 when he tried to escape (his identity was not then known) (M erdeka, November 13,1948, p. 3). Amir, Suripno, and Mardjono were captured on December 1, 1948 (Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 116; Kahin, N ationalism , p. 300). Djokosujono, Maruto Darusman, Sardjono, Francisca Fangiday surrendered to Siliwangi leader Kemal Id ris on November 29,1948, near Purwodadi (Pinardi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 116). Alimin, Tan Ling Djie, and others had been captured in or near Yogyakarta, but Aidit and Lukman es caped, as did Wikana and Sumarsono.
CHAPTERV E pilogue and C onclusion
Who was responsible for Madiun? So many myths have grown up and so many prob lems remain unsolved, that the question will probably remain to puzzle historians for years to come. It is clear that Musso’s return had a dramatic effect on the Indonesian political scene, for in reorganizing the PKI he made it conform to the image of the “revolutionary Communist party” current in the world press of the time. H atta’s government reacted strongly to this sudden appearance in its midst of an orthodox Stalinist party with its over tones of direction from Moscow. The left wing, on the other hand, was elated by the new dynamism of Musso’s doctrine, which called for the PKI to take its “rightful place” at the head of the national revolution. The thought of the Indonesian revolution in the hands of the now-orthodox PKI, how ever, was totally unpalatable to government supporters who were convinced (mainly by the Communists’ own propaganda) that once in power the PKI would be unlikely to share or surrender that power. As conservative opposition to the Communists mounted, the PKI in turn grew to suspect that H atta’s government would not resign except under threat (or use) of force. This belief was, of course, confirmed by the Communist doctrine of the time, which taught that the National Bourgeoisie (the H atta government), to retain power, might even be willing to cooperate with the Imperialists (the United States abetted by the Dutch) to defeat any challenge from the left. Each side was wary of the other and ready for trouble, but did one strike first? Did the Hatta government plot to provoke an incident by the PKI or did the PKI fail in a plan to seize power by force? Am erican Provocation Before the events of Madiun, the Communists undoubtedly felt that the H atta govern ment was about to move against their forces and that they must take some action for self protection. Communist propaganda had been intimating for some time that the H atta government was in league with the Dutch to sell out the Indonesian revolution.1*The ques tion of an “American Plot,” however, was not raised until after Madiun, and then not by the Indonesians themselves but by the Dutch Communists. The “provocation theory” of Madiun, which has become standard Communist doctrine, has gone through several vari ations: from the original Dutch Communist theory of October 1948, to the Russian adop tion of this idea in January 1949, to French reporter Roger Vailland’s confused version published in Boroboudour, Voyage à Bali, Java et autres Iles of 1951, and finally to the offi1 Sin M in, September 9,1948, reported that SOBSI (Yogyakarta) had accused the government o f working with the Dutch. A lso see Suara Ibu K ota, September 17,1948, for a late version o f this accusation.
81
82 cial PKI version put out in Bintang Merah, August/September 1951, which was then re peated in Aidit’s defense of the Madiun Affair of 1953. The original Dutch version of the “provocation theory” was presented to the Dutch Parliament by Dutch Communist leader Paul de Groot sometime in early October 1948. De Groot charged that Charlton Ogborn, at that time political advisor to the US delega tion to the UN Committee of Good Offices, had met with Sukarno and H atta in July 1948 in Sarangan. In this Sarangan meeting, the US was said to have promised to send arms and technical advisors to Indonesia if the Republic would act against the Communists. The offer was, according to this version, accepted and resulted in the government-inspired provocation at Madiun which gave Hatta the opportunity to move against the PKI.2 De Groot’s accusation was denied at the time by the Republican information minister, Mo hammad Natsir, and later Republican sources were to point out that, while there had in deed been a meeting in Sarangan in July, this well-publicized affair had been a meeting of the UN Good Offices Committee members Critchley (Australia), Ogborn (US), and Herremans (Belgium) with Sukarno to see if there was any possibility of getting the badly stalled Renville talks back on track.3 The PKI version of the “provocation theory,” put forth by Bintang Merah and PKI leader Aidit in the early 1950s, unfortunately added to this shaky Dutch story some frills drawn from Vailland’s fanciful version.4 Bintang Merah claimed that on July 21,1948, a meeting was held in Sarangan between the Indonesians (Sukarno, Hatta, Natsir, Sukiman, Roem, and Police Chief Soekanto)5 and the Americans (Ambassador Merle Cochran and Gerard Hopkins, a political advisor to President Truman). This meeting was said to have resulted in the “Red Drive Proposals,” under which the Republic would be given $56 mil lion to “destroy the democratic anti-imperialist peoples movement” (i.e., the PKI). Ac cording to this account, the Hatta government promptly used three million rupiahs of this US fund to bribe Dr. Muwardi of the GRR to cause the incidents in Solo which, together with the Siliwangi-aided kidnappings, sparked the “Madiun Affair.”6 The problem with this PKI version is that Merle Cochran did not arrive in Indonesia until August 9, 1948,
2 Voice o f Free Indonesia, October 28,1948, pp. 1-2; M erdeka, November 16,1948. 3 Ibid.; Sukarno’s meeting with the GOC members, July 18-21,1948, was reported in K engP o, July 14,1948, p. 1, and July 21,1948, p. 1. It is not mentioned in the cable traffic included in FR U S1948. 4 Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1948, pp. 40-41; D . N. Aidit, “The August 1945 Revolution and the Role of Traitors to the Nation” in Fakta dan D okum ent vol. 3, pt. 7, pp. 77-79. The Bintang Merah story, “Tiga Tahun Provokasi Madiun” by Mirajadi, refers in the text to Vailland’s book, probably in an attempt to avoid trouble and make their story sound more authentic by quoting foreign sources. See Roger Vailland, Boroboudour. Voyage a Bali, Java et Autres lies (Paris: Correa, 1951), pp. 73,154. 5 The police chief mentioned, R. Sukamto [sic], seems to have become involved in this story because o f his US training. In July 1948, Police Chief Raden said Soekanto was appointed to go on “an inspection trip abroad,” and he did not resume his duties until December 16, 1949 [sic—1948?] according to Oudang, Pekembangan Kepolisian, pp. 65, 76. Mirajadi in ‘T iga Tahun,” p. 41, says that Soekanto was sent to the United States for training in 1948. It would certainly have been unusual for the United States to be offering training for Repub lican officials in mid-1948 unless they had permission from the Dutch, and one wonders if training was not of fered Soekanto after he got to the States on a tour. The US government does not seem to have taken a real interest in the possibilities o f working with Republican police forces until after Madiun, although “police force material” was apparently discussed by the Indonesians with the US attache sometime just prior to September 18. There is no indication anything was offered by the US. (FRUS 1948, vol. 6, p. 358.) 6 Bintang Merah, August/Septem ber 1948, pp. 41-43.
83 and “G. Hopkins” is either a mistaken reference to FDR advisor Harry Hopkins or a flight of imagination.7 While it is obvious that the Sarangan meeting is pure fancy, the question of the actual American role in the events of August and September 1948 is more difficult to answer. In 1948, the United States had only a very minimal interest in Southeast Asia; its troops had been withdrawn from the region since World War II, a feeling of disillusionment over Chiang Kai-shek’s losing battle with Mao Tse-tung was growing, and the US, while proFrench, was playing a hands-off role in Indochina.8 In Indonesia, US companies had some valuable investments,9 but US interest in Indonesian internal affairs in early 1948 seemed minimal and the US had only a small consulate in Batavia, a negotiating team at the GOC, and some military observers also attached to the GOC. Washington’s attitude toward the Indonesian situation during the 1947-1948 period appeared to be determined more by a desire to strengthen the Dutch as allies against the Soviet bloc in Europe than by a desire to protect the Indonesian Republic from Dutch re conquest.10 This attitude was plainly reflected in the US grant of Marshall Plan aid to Holland and in American efforts to mediate some sort of cessation of hostilities in Indone sia that would be acceptable to the Dutch. While the United States, through its new GOC representative Merle Cochran, worked hard to achieve an agreement with the Dutch which would strengthen H atta’s government against the Communists, Washington was unwilling to send economic or military assistance to the Indonesians until such an agree ment was reached. US interest in finding an agreement between the Dutch and Indonesians increased dramatically as the State Department in late August and early September became con cerned that the new FDR/PKI might be able to bring down the moderate H atta govern ment and install a government which would be “strongly left wing if not communist con trolled.”11 Ambassador Merle Cochran arrived in Batavia on August 9 to head the US delegation to the GOC and immediately set about an intensive series of meetings with the Indonesians and Dutch in an attempt to calm the tensions which threatened to flare into open conflict at any moment. These negotiations brought Cochran and other members of his staff into close contact with Sukarno and Hatta, especially in the weeks directly preced ing Madiun.12*In August and September, cables between the State Department, Cochran, 7 Berita Indonesia, August 10,1948, gives Cochran’s arrival date. Cochran left the United States for the Neth erlands in late July, arriving in Amsterdam July 30 and going on to The Hague for meetings. H e departed the Netherlands August 5 for Indonesia (FRU S1948, pp. 299-300; also see H arian Indonesia, July 31,1948, p. 1). 8 See The Pentagon Papers, Gravel Edition, pp. 28-36, for a discussion of US policy towards Vietnam in 19471949. 9 Roth, “American Flip Flop,” p. 40, estimates that U S investments in Indonesia totaled $3 billion, mainly in oil and rubber (Standard Oil, Stanvac, Caltex, Goodyear, and US Rubber). 10 Taylor, Indonesian Independence, p. 398. 11 FRUS 1948, vol. 6, p. 312, a cable from the Secretary of State to the Consulate General in Batavia, August 31,1948. From his arrival in Indonesia, Ambassador Cochran used the threat of possible fall o f the Hatta gov ernment constantly to push the State Department for more pressure on the Dutch government in the negotia tions (ibid., pp. 307,312,323-24). Andrew Roth in “American Flip Flop,” p. 39, speculated that pro-Indonesia elem ents in the US State Department were using the “Red Menace” in Southeast Asia to bring about a change in US policy toward the Dutch/Indonesian negotiations until late 1948 (see Taylor, Indonesian Independence, pp. 398-400). 12 The meetings with Hatta and Sukarno took place in Yogyakarta, starting with a courtesy call on August 12 and continuing with meetings on August 16 and 17, September 3, September 13, and September 17. The sub-
84 and Consul General Livengood in Batavia reflect a growing concern that the H atta gov ernment might fall from leftist pressure if the US was unable to shore it up by helping to produce an acceptable agreement with the Dutch.13 Ambassador Cochran’s role is key as far as the US actions were concerned in the days before Madiun, because of his frequent contact with H atta and Sukarno. Cochran was known as an anti-Communist, and he had just come from a stint inspecting US missions in the USSR and Eastern Europe where he had a close look at Communist methods.14 In the weeks following his arrival, he was to prove himself a strong backer of the Sukarno/Hatta government, which he saw as the only viable alternative to the Communists.15 The main subject of Cochran’s talks with the two leaders (at least as reflected in the cables in Foreign Relations o f the United States, 1948) were the Renville Agreements.16 There is little indica tion of what Cochran said on domestic issues. Hatta and Sukarno undoubtedly kept him fully informed of the increasingly tense political situation.17 For his part, Cochran proba bly discussed his concern at the possibility of a Communist takeover and may well have urged Sukarno and Hatta to take strong measures to protect themselves. He may also have pointed out that the US government would look more favorably on a Southeast Asian government which was demonstrably anti-Communist.18 However, Cochran does not seem to have had any arms or supplies he could offer,19 nor is there any indication he was urging the Indonesians to take military action against the Communists. From Washington, the picture seems much the same. While the US was plainly inter ested in containing or, if possible, eliminating Communist influence in the Republic, as State Department Undersecretary Lovett was to tell Dutch Foreign Minister Stikker on September 17, there is no indication in the cables that the State Department intended to take an active role against the Communists.20 On September 6, a “High Republican” (who
ject of conversation at all these meetings was Ambassador Cochran’s attempt to get Republican agreement to his new draft agreement. (FRU S1948, vol. 6, pp. 301,303-4,323,338, and 342-43.) 13 Ibid., pp. 307,312, 323-24, 345. In these cables and reports, the US seemed convinced that, if Hatta could come to a good agreement with the Dutch, this would strengthen his hand against the Communists. There is also the strong suggestion, however, in the cables that the Americans felt that Hatta feared that should he sign an agreement with the Dutch the FDR/Communists would resist it with force (ibid., pp. 325,327). 14 Berita Indonesia, August 13,1948, for USIS-supplied biographic sketch o f Ambassador Cochran. 15 FRUS 1948, vol. 6, pp. 307, 322-24. While Cochran was a committed anti-Communist, he appears to have been fairly moderate in his approach to dealing with the Communist problem in Indonesia. On October 10, 1948, he told the Department of State: “I cannot agree with idea that it would be effective or wise to ask Re public to outlaw communism. The government is obviously doing its best to put down uprising. Question arises whether outlawing communism is the most effective measure to be followed anywhere.” (Ibid., p. 404.) 16 See note 12 above. Cochran had submitted a new plan for agreement with the Dutch which was accepted by the Republic on September 20,1948. (Ibid., p. 359; also see Taylor, Indonesian Independence, pp. 142-43.) 17 FRUS 1948, vol. 6, p. 323. Sukarno and Hatta undoubtedly also made use of the American fear of the grow ing power o f Communists to try to lever the US into pushing the Dutch into a more forthcoming position in the negotiations. 18 Ibid., p. 357. O f course, Coert Dubois, Cochran’s predecessor, had already made precisely this point to the Republicans at the time of the USSR-Indonesian agreement in May (ibid., p. 194). 19 See note 22 below. 20 FRUS 1948, vol. 6, pp. 345-46. Undersecretary Lovett was second in rank to Secretary Marshall at this time. His comments to Foreign Minister Stikker thus give a very authoritative version of US policy toward Indonesia on September 17, the eve of Madiun. The memorandum of conversation quotes Lovett as saying: “I pointed out that Mr. Cochran as well as the Department were determined that the growing Communist strength in
85 may have been Masyumi from other comments in the cable) informed the Consulate General in Batavia that: H atta prepared to take a strong action against intransigent elements, that Hatta can negotiate and sign an agreement, that there will be diffi culties in implementation of agreement and H atta will require assis tance. Further, that Dutch offered assistance but Republic refused. When source queried, indicated that Republic might accept assistance from purely Indo troops possibly under supervision of Santoso but cer tainly no direction or guidance from General Spoor and would refuse to have any Dutch officers or troops involved. Finally source said H atta desires to know US official stand particularly regarding assistance to Republic against Communists.21 It is impossible to determine if this “source” was really approaching the US Consulate on orders from Hatta. In any case, the reply from the State Department was very cautious, assuring H atta of Washington’s support against communism, but saying this could best be achieved through agreement with the Dutch and offering economic assistance once a peaceful federation was set up.22
Indonesia be contained and, if possible, eliminated; that we felt the Communist threat could be met within the Republic only by Hatta since the intrusion of the Dutch in the Republic would, we believed, immediately po larize nationalism and communism in a common front against Netherlands aggression. I said that it appeared to us that Indonesian nationalism must be accommodated in a just and practical way as a condition precedent to dealing with Communism in that area and that for these very reasons, Mr. Cochran had offered his plan in the most expeditious way possible in the belief that its acceptance by both parties would strengthen Mr. Hatta and his government sufficiently to enable him successfully to liquidate Communists within the Republic.” While the above may sound a bit warlike because o f Lovett’s use o f words like “liquidate,” he was plainly not thinking o f immediate action. Later in the memorandum he defends Cochran’s suggestion of elections in January 1949 against Dutch fears that the Communists might win (ibid., p. 346) and Department officers in the meeting apparently argued that, although elections were a calculated risk, Hatta would win (ibid., p. 355). 21 Ibid., p. 325. 22 Ibid., p. 327. The State Department reply to the “Hatta request” was sent to the Consulate General at Batavia September 9. It stated: “Department appreciates info Congentel 763 Sep 7 and is deeply concerned Communist threat to present moderate Repub regime. Accordingly if you think desirable, you may in your discretion communicate to Hatta following: a. U S Govt will in every practical way assist democratic non-communist govt o f Indonesia successfully to resist Communist tyranny. b. D ept believes stability Hatta regime best assured through acceptance both parties just and practical set tlement Dutch-Repub dispute. US now making every effort find basis such settlem ent___ c. D ept will support extension financial help in which all states o f peaceful federation Indonesia would share according to their needs and dependent upon their capacity utilize shares o f loans efficiently and as sound borrow ers.. . . ” Apparently at som e point before Madiun, the US Military Attache had discussed with the Indonesians some sort o f Indonesian request for “police force material.” Nothing seem s to have come o f this request as on September 20 in a conversation with Cochran after Madiun, Hatta says, “Republic seriously needs police force material discussed with US attache and now ammunition and weapons for use against Communist enemy.” (Ibid., p. 358.) Cochran gave Hatta the same reply which the State Department had sent September 9 that fi nancial help would be available once a peaceful Indonesian federation was established (ibid., p. 358). A s late as September 27, the Department of State was concerned with reports that Hatta might be trying to find a settlem ent with the Communists which would give them a seat in his government, and it ordered Co chran to express his concern to Republican officials at such a possibility. Even at this point, however, the Department cautions Cochran carefully that it is not prepared to offer Hatta a “quid pro quo” for action against the Communists. (Ibid., pp. 378-79.)
86 The Madiun coup appears to have come as a complete surprise to Cochran at Kaliurang, and to the Consulate General in Batavia, both of whom seem to have received the new? of >,iadiun from Sukarno’s radio broadcast on September 19.23 The US, however, was jubilant immediately after the coup. Asked by the press for their comments, the State Department on September 20 pointed out sagely that it had recently warned the world that the Communists were up to no good in Southeast Asia.24 On the same day (September 20), Cochran told Hatta in Yogyakarta that, “I cabled Department Republican communi que on action against Communist uprising. I said while outbreak regretted, crisis gives Republican Government opportunity show determination suppress communism.”25 In Jakarta, US consulate officials by October 1 were calling Madiun “the first Communist defeat” in arms since the end of World War II. These “US officials” told a Singapore Straits Tim es correspondent that “the fall of Madiun strengthens Premier H atta’s position because, firstly, it presents concrete evidence that the Republican government is non communist and, secondly, it offers proof that the Republic is strong enough militarily to put down such disturbances.”26 Any US warning before Madiun would have fallen on receptive ears, as the H atta gov ernment was undoubtedly already convinced by what they had seen of the FD R/PK I anti government campaign, actions among the peasantry, and Musso’s fiery oratory that trouble was just around the corner. Hatta was well aware that anti-Communist actions would find favor in the United States, but whether he was naive enough to believe that this would bring any concrete change in US pro-Dutch policy is doubtful. Hatta, however, knew also that Dutch Foreign Minister Stikker would arrive in the US on September 16 for talks, which would be aimed at convincing US officials that the Republic was a hotbed of Communists and that the Dutch government would be doing the US a favor by launch ing a new police action to put an end to this problem once and for all.27 The timing, as far as the Hatta government was concerned,was perfect for anti-Communist moves if they wished to take some of the wind out of Stikker’s sails, and once the Madiun rising got underway, the firm government reaction undoubtedly took these factors into consideration. It does seem doubtful, however, that the Hatta government would have purposely attempted, as claimed by the PKI, to force the PKI into rebellion. No government seeks civil war, and for the consensus-conscious Indonesians in the midst of their national revolution, this was particularly true. The Hatta government, however, was fearful of PKI military capabilities and how they might be used. It is quite possible that the government was slowly moving to remove PKI armed capabilities in Solo. W hether or not
23 Ibid., pp. 353-57. 24 Berita Indonesia, September 22,1948: The US reaction to the coup which had been announced on the 19th was not as rapid as it seems. Indonesia is twelve hours ahead of Eastern Standard Time. The US State D e partment prophecy was made on September 16,1948. 25 Ibid., p. 357. 26 Straits Times, October 2,1948, p. 1. 27 M erdeka, September 16,1948, and September 18,1948; Berita Indonesia, September 18,1948. Stikker’s trip was officially to meet with Secretary o f State Marshall before he took a trip through Europe to discuss Marshall Plan aid. The Dutch, o f course, wanted as much aid as possible, untied by restrictions on its use. Stikker made several statements to the press on communism in the Republic. The Dutch had warned the United States o f their intentions before the first police action, and it is quite possible that Stikker was prepar ing the ground again. Certainly everyone in Indonesia was waiting for the Dutch to advance.
87 this can be considered sufficient justification by a political party for open rebellion against a legal (majority) government is debatable. The M oscow P lot While the PKI may have felt it was “provoked” into the Madiun uprising, it is clear that the H atta government was equally convinced both that Moscow was in some manner con nected to Musso’s return and that the PKI was plotting to take over the government. The coup justified their suspicions and they promptly set out to use the “Moscow Plot” thesis against their PKI enemies. Immediately after the coup, the Republic’s Ministry of Infor mation issued a statement that the coup “probably is part of Moscow’s plan for a South east Asia under the leadership of Musso [sic]”;28 and on September 20, a radio broadcast from Yogyakarta announced that documents had been found showing that a “red coup” had been planned to take place in Java within three months of the outbreak of fighting in Malaya, as part of the spread of communism to Southeast Asia.29 Republican circles also circulated the spurious story that Radio Moscow had, on September 19, reported the news of a “People’s Government” in Madiun, thus indicating by their rapid knowledge that they were aware of the plot all along.30 The US government promptly seconded the Indonesian interpretation of “Moscow plots,” putting statements out through USIS in Jakarta whole heartedly agreeing.31 As discussed in Chapter IV, however, there is no way of telling what Moscow’s relations were with Musso. Certainly the Zhdanov line as used by Southeast Asian Communist parties gave an excellent justification for revolt, but it remains unclear if the Soviets had a hand in urging these parties actually to fight. Whatever the case, Moscow was plainly taken off balance by Madiun and reacted with all signs of total befuddlement. There was no Soviet reporting of the Madiun Affair until September 25, when Pruvda mentioned the “conflict taking place between the Communists and the rightist national party.”32 The Russian line on Madiun did not start to clarify until October 15, when Pravda ran a mild version (quoting Dutch Communist sources) indicating that Madiun was a provocation.33 While Moscow allowed some criticism in its press, no hint of criticism over H atta’s han dling of the rebellion was voiced by the Soviets at the UN,34 and it was not until January 5 that the full provocation theory with US involvement was run in the New Times?5 Thus,
28 N ew York Tim es, September 20,1948, p. 10, quoting AP report o f September 19,1948. 29 N ew York Tim es, September 21,1948, p. 21. 30 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 294. 31 Berita Indonesia, September 24,1948, and M erdeka, September 24,1948. The USIS hand-out said informed sources in Washington say the PKI actions may have been instigated in Moscow. It is interesting to note that a Department o f State, Office o f Intelligence, research survey o f Com munist influence in Southeast Asia in the fall of 1948, while apparently finding “evidence” o f a Moscow-di rected conspiracy everywhere but Vietnam, was still phrasing its internal documents somewhat hesitantly: “If there is a Moscow-directed conspiracy in Southeast Asia, Indochina is an anomaly so far” {Pentagon Papers, Gravel Edition, p. 34). 32 McVey, Soviet View, p. 77. 33 See ibid., pp. 71-75, for a full discussion o f the Soviet response. 34 Taylor, Indonesian Independence, p. 387. 35 N ew Times, January 5,1949, p. 8.
88 while the possibility that Moscow may have discussed Communist revolution with Musso and the PKI can not be ruled out, it seems clear that Moscow’s hand was not present at Madiun itself and that the Soviets, like almost everyone else, were taken off guard. The M isfire Theory As mentioned earlier, both sides at Madiun had been suspicious of the intentions of the other: the PKI, especially younger leaders like Sumarsono, felt certain that the Hatta gov ernment was about to move against them, and the government, for its part, especially after Musso’s return, was convinced it was only a matter of time before the PKI moved to seize the government. Government agencies (the police and army) had been keeping track of plot rumors like those floated by Murba in April, but there is little indication they had found anything serious.36 Once the coup broke, however, it was obviously helpful to the government to have proof that the PKI had been plotting for some time and could thus shoulder the entire blame for the events at Madiun. Most Indonesians, too, were probably sincerely con vinced that the PKI had been plotting (especially as Indonesian politics do tend to be con spiratorial) and it was now only a matter of discovering how. The compulsion to discover a “conspiracy” is seen most clearly in Sukarno’s radio address to the nation on September 19,1948. Here, to convince the people of the PKI’s long-standing guilt, Sukarno quoted sections from the Murba “plot” documents of April which previously had been considered a Murba fabrication.37 Then on September 20, the government released the word that documents had been found during the sweeps for PKI members on Sunday, September 19, showing that the PKI revolt was part of the Communist plot to take over Southeast Asia.38 Finally, on Thursday, November 23,1948, Radio Yogyakarta announced that the govern ment had proof that the coup had actually been planned for November, and had misfired in September because PKI leaders had been stampeded into action by the events in Solo.39 No documents were released (nor were they ever to be), but on September 28, the Minis try of Defense announced that it had captured documents inYogyakarta which related to the coup and described efforts by the PKI to infiltrate the army and to set up its own secret army.40*According to Persatoean, September 30, the Defense Ministry announced that this “Musso Plan” concerned efforts to set up an illegal army and to hold demonstrations which would then lead to strikes and to rebellion. Plans had been made to make Madiun
36 Police Report, August 20, 1948, p. 2, discusses rumored “FDR plans for seizing power” which called in last resort for setting up an action committee for the seizure o f power in the “Kediri-Madiun” area. The report is skeptical o f the authenticity o f these reports. A lso see Nasution, TNI, 2: 235, which says the Siliwangi had heard o f plots for som e time and was keeping track o f them. 37 See Sukarno speech, Appendix B. A lso see Kahin, N ationalism , p. 269, on the authenticity of the Murba document. 38 N ew York Times, September 20,1948, quoting AP report of September 19,1948. 39 Berita Indonesia, September 24,1948, p. 1: Radio Yogyakarta quoting N asional which in turn was quoting Radio Republic Indonesia. The date o f the Yogyakarta broadcast is in question and it may have been as late as September 24. 40 Voice o f Free Indonesia, September 28,1948, quoting D efense M inistiy Communique No. 4. The documents were supposed to have been found in Amir’s house either on the 29th (Nasution, 7M , 2: 236) or on the 21st (Dr. Mula Marbun, Gerakan Operasi M iliter I untuk M enumpas Peristiwa M adiun [Jakarta: Pusat Sedjarah Angkatan Bersendjata, 1965], p. 4).
89 the center of PKI activities and Solo a “wild west.”41 The documents were not released publicly, however, and the Persatoean correspondent on October 6 complained bitterly that he had been unable to locate them through the Ministry of Defense and the Ministry of Information and questioned if they really existed.42 Some time after the coup, probably in October, George Kahin was briefly allowed to see these documents at the Ministry of Information and quotations from them appear in his book Nationalism and Revolution in Indonesia.43 (Also see Appendix A.) The papers shown Kahin are the ones mentioned in the Ministry of Defense communique and, as stated above, they detail plans to take over the Republic by force if other efforts failed. It is difficult to ascertain the authenticity of these documents. Use of forged documents for political purposes is not an unknown technique in Indonesian politics. Murba had appar ently forged FDR documents in April, which Sukarno had not hesitated to use in his radio address.44 The Kahin documents themselves, which are supposed to have been written in mid-July, follow very closely, almost too closely, the actual events of September 13-18. Solo, the document stated, would be turned into a “wild west” (i.e., an area of agitation and general lawlessness) to draw attention away from Madiun, which would be made the “strongest guerrilla stronghold for the long-term struggle.”45 If the documents were au thentic, they would prove, however, that contingency plans at least had been made for revolt well before Musso’s arrival. The PKI, of course, has always denied it had any plan for revolt. As Suripno was to say after his capture, “to my knowledge the PKI never discussed or accepted any plan to carry out an opposition based on use of arms.”46 Amir, however, was slightly more equivocal, at least as his conversation was reported by Catholic paper H idup’s correspondent. Amir protested that the documents being used by the government were Murba forgeries that the PKI had already taken to court (he may have been referring only to the ones used in Sukarno’s speech). However, said Amir, if a coup had been planned for example, this was hardly the time, “because it is not possible to use fighting forces, if political forces are not yet consolidated, and we still desired to consolidate our political forces first.”47 Amir’s statement, of course, would fit in neatly, if indeed it has been correctly reported, with the proposition that the PKI was planning a coup of some type, but not until November or later. Regardless of the Kahin documents’ authenticity, no one will ever be able to say defi nitely whether the PKI was plotting a takeover of the Indonesian government in late 1948 or whether they still felt in mid-September that, by consolidating their forces, they would 41 Persatoean, September 30,1948, p. 1. 42 Ibid., October 6,1948, p. 4. 43 Kahin, N ationalism , pp. 269-71. Kahin is the only source available for these documents as they have never been published by the Indonesian government. 44 Another celebrated forgery case is the “Gilchrist letter” o f 1965. This was apparently forged by Subandrio and the PKI to “prove” the U S and Britain were involved in a plot with the Indonesian army to overthrow Sukarno. 45 Kahin, N ationalism , p. 271. 46 Marsudi, Peristiwa M adiun, p. 79, from “Tulisan Suripno dalam Pendjara Sala.” The origin of these Suripno “writings” is not mentioned by Marsudi but from a close reading of the text the contents would seem authentic. 47 H idup, Decem ber 18,1948, p. 3.
90 be able to force the Hatta government to resign legally. One thing is certain, however: there could be no question of a coalition government. The new government would have to be PKI-led. In the turmoil of Indonesian politics in 1948, both sides had probably drawn up contingency plans for offensive and defensive actions, and it is very likely that the FD R/PK I had discussed the possibility of armed rebellion.48 Both sides also had hotheads desirous of putting these plans into action. Sumarsono probably moved in Madiun with out prior permission of the PKI leaders, but no one will ever know if he was moving only prematurely along lines already discussed with Musso and Amir just ten days before, dur ing Musso’s Madiun visit on the 8th, or whether he was simply responding to events in Solo which he interpreted as forerunners of an all-out government attack on the PKI. A n Open Ending On December 18,1948, the Dutch at long last openly broke the uneasy truce which had lasted since the signing of the Renville Agreements in January and sent their troops into the Republic to capture Yogyakarta and arrest the Republic’s leaders, Sukarno and Hatta. The renewed Dutch attack provided the motivation for Indonesians on all sides of the political spectrum once more to set aside their differences in the face of an external threat. When news was received of the new Dutch attack, all but a few of the 35,000 PKI prison ers49 from the Madiun uprising were set free. Only the top PKI leadership, most impor tantly Musso, Amir, and Maruto Darusman, were held responsible by the government for leading the left wing of the revolution astray by introducing foreign (Moscow-bred) ideas into domestic politics. While even they might eventually have been released, in the face of the Dutch attack orders went out that the top PKI leaders (including Amir) captured after Madiun should be executed rather than released or allowed to fall into Dutch hands.50 Responsibility for this order has never been established, but plainly someone in the gov ernment or army, fearful of the PKI leaders’ appeal during a guerrilla war against the Dutch, had acted. Most of the PKI’s supporters, however, including some of the PKI troop commanders, were welcomed back as they picked up their weapons to fight once more for the national revolution. The PKI was never formally banned after Madiun and the role of the left during the second “police action” made possible the gradual acceptance of a “rehabilitated” party after independence. To come to an end without an ending is difficult and somewhat unsatisfactory, but Madiun does not readily lend itself to easy answers, and the reader must decide for him self. Was Madiun a coup or a provocation? Probably it was neither. The Hatta govern ment undoubtedly wanted to extend its control over all of Indonesia’s armed forces, but that they would purposely instigate a rebellion in their midst strains the imagination. On
48 McVcy in Soviet View, p. 70, comments “A s for the actual intentions of the government and the commu nists, it is perhaps sufficient to remark that it was apparent to both before the rebellion that the likelihood of civil war in the near future was exceedingly great; and it would be foolish for either of them to refrain from making plans for such an eventuality.” 49 Minggu Pagi, December 12,1948, announced that 35,000 prisoners had been taken and were awaiting trial. Hatta told Cochran that the Republic had taken 40,000 prisoners (FRU S1948, vol. 6, p. 523). 50 Aidit, “The Madiun Affair was indeed a Provocation,” in Kementerian Luar Negeri, F acta, vol. 7, p. 106, says that on December 19, eleven PKI leaders were shot, according to Aidit on orders from Gatot Subroto: Amir Sjarifuddin, Maruto Darusman, Suripno, Oey Gee Hwat, Sardjono, Haijono, Djokosujono, Sukarno, Katamhadi Ronomarsono, and D . Mangku (the last three probably being lower-level leaders unfortunately caught with the group to be executed).
91 the other hand, a “coup” is usually thought of as a well- (or badly-) laid plot to seize the reins of the government in the capital city. Madiun, on the other hand, if a fine distinction may be drawn, was a revolt rather than a coup: a revolt by lower echelon PKI leaders who took over the legitimate government in a provincial capital and set up a revolutionary gov ernment, hoping to rally support from Yogyakarta to their banners. When Musso and other PKI leaders decided to take over full control of the Madiun revolt and issued calls for all the people to rise against the Sukarno-Hatta government, the revolt then became a full-scale rebellion against the central government. One of the main puzzles which will remain unanswerable is whether or not Madiun would have occurred without Musso. While the FDR had moved further and further into opposition during the first seven months of 1948, even as late as mid-August the FDR’s leaders (whether or not they had contingency plans for revolt) were leaving the door open for compromise with the H atta government. Through mid-August issues of Indonesian politics were still being fought out in mainly domestic terms, and even those in the FDR seemed to think of themselves more as nationalists than as an active part of an Interna tional Communist Movement. Musso’s arrival brought with it the creation of a new political force in Indonesian poli tics which was clearly identified with Moscow, and injected into the newly formed PKI a doctrine of international communism which left little room for compromise with other elements of the national revolution. Indonesia, this doctrine said, must side with Moscow in the international struggle against imperialism and her national revolution must be led by the Communists. As the PKI became more strident in its demands, Indonesia’s right wing in turn hardened its determination to meet what it now clearly perceived as a “Com munist threat” to its position in the Indonesian revolution. After Musso’s arrival, a clash seemed almost unavoidable, but without Musso would Amir have led his FDR on so clearly divisive a path?
A ppendix A M urba D ocument:* P eople’s D emocratic F ront
Implementation of the decisions of the People’s Democratic Front for the expansion of its power is based on the following: 1. a. The Presidential Cabinet should be dissolved and be changed as quickly as pos sible into a parliamentary cabinet in accordance with the promise of the Vice Presi dent in a meeting with the FDR on 24-26 January 1948. (If possible in a month.) b. The parliamentary cabinet must be formed by the FDR. 2. The present cabinet is obviously not an expert cabinet but a Masjumi cabinet under cover of Vice President Hatta. The FDR by all means can not accept this Masjumi cabinet, because this government will obviously smell of God and the Moslem reli gious leaders can take arbitrary actions. It is clear that the principle of socialismcommunism is contrary to religion. 3. This cabinet will certainly not able to execute the 4 points programme of the gov ernment as it does not fulfill the conditions. (See statements of the Sajap Kiri.) 4. The FDR can not permit Amir Sjarifuddin to become Chairman of the Delegation and Amir consequently must resign. Amir must return in the cabinet at least as the Minister of Defence. We thereby retain the key-position and can also finance our parties. Amir has done very much for the parties. 5.
We must clarify: a. Who is really breaking the unity of the people, b. Why Amir cabinet resign, c. Why the FDR can not participate in the Hatta-cabinet. d. Regarding the national unity, we still will try to establish that unity with the conditions which can strengthen that unity and also our history and our ideology, e. the absolute condi tion for the attainment of the national independence is the concerted action of the workers, peasants, youths. We must therefore use the statement of the FDR as our guidance.
* Professor Kahin has a note at the end o f the document that it is very possibly a forgery.
93
94 6. The ways of staging the campaign for reaching the objective as implied in the first phase: 1. The actions in the regions should be in proportion and according to stages. 2. The action in cities and town (workers and youth) should be in proportion with the actions taken in the villages (peasants and youths). 3. In this phase and in consideration with article 6 clause 1, it is not yet the time to proclaim strikes and boycotts; when the time has come instructions will be is sued. 4. The actions of the FDR in phase should be concentrated on propaganda by means of: a. public meetings, b. closed meetings, c. holding meetings with other parties and organizations such as PNI, PSII, Masjumi, Parkindo, BPRI, etc., d. to hold meetings with government officials, the police and army, especially with the lower ranks, e. press-campaign, f. pamphlets, posters, radio speeches and using other propaganda means. 5. The greatest number of new members should be recruited, especially after the meetings. 6. In all propaganda religion should not be molested. On the contrary it should be suggested to the people who have a certain religion that they guard the sacred ness of their religion. We must be on our guard that religion is not used by lead ers for their own benefit. This means that the FDR agrees with religion with its delicate teachings. However the attainment of the socialist-communist ideals is our aim. If the power is already in our hands, ‘all is running well’. 7. All meetings mentioned in article 6 clause 4 sub clause a, b, c, d must be as much as possible be held on behalf of the FDR, not on behalf of one of its parties, al though the meetings are not organized by all parties of the FDR. 8. The groups which break the unity of action of workers, peasants and youths must be attacked in various fields: government, parliament, mass organization, trade unions, BTI, etc. 9. According to article 28 of the Constitution the members of the Army are not prohibited to stage demonstrations in the quality of citizens. 10. We must take care that the radical left (the groups which attempted to over throw the government in 1946) does not profit by our endeavours and uncover the mask of our actions. 11. Next to the above mentioned means and the above mentioned campaign im plied in article 6, illegal and positive action should be taken. a. to create disorders everywhere, as long as the Masjumi cabinet is in office, by mobilizing all criminal gangs to plunder and commit robbery intensively day and night. The police force is not strong enough yet to suppress all this. If this can be done efficiently and properly the whole people will live in constant fear and consequently the government will loose the confidence of the people.
95 b. strong measures must be taken such as kidnapping if necessary against those persons (including those who have withdrawn from the FDR) who are combat ing the plans of the FDR, the Party Buruh Merdeka (Independent Labour Party), S.B.G. (Sugar Workers Union) and the like.
Decision of the ad interim (day-today) council on 5 /2 -’48 (Implementing the decision of the Plenery Council of 26/27 January 1948.
Central Secretariat. People’s Democratic Front (Sajap Kiri) Labour Party Socialist Party Communist Party Pesindo
Collection of Professor George McT. Kahin
A ppendix B R adio S peech B y P resident S ukarno on the M adiun C oup (SEPTEMBER 19,1948 at 10 PM) Merdeka, Brothers! Last night I have spoken to you. Again tonight I am compelled to do so. Listen, brothers! At this moment our Fatherland is facing a great ordeal. While we are involved in a conflict with the Dutch which requires the absolute solidarity of our people behind the Government, while unity is of the utmost importance for our country’s sake, this people’s unity is broken by a group of rebels. A sound political campaign is necessary for the development and growth of our democ racy. The Government clearly stated, through the Vice-President before the Working Committee of the K.N.I.P. on the 16th of this month, that it has no intention to suppress a particular ideology. But on the contrary it respects the right of the citizens to adhere to whatsoever ideology they wish. All acts of anarchy, however, from whatever side they may emanate, and all insurgents, who endanger the country and the public safety will be elimi nated. The Government directs its corrective measures only against such acts and against these insurgents. Lately there have taken place a considerable number of activities calculated to create unrest and disorder. It is very evident, that these activities have been conducted by more than one plotter-w ho perhaps have no relations with one another. But they do have one purpose, to overthrow the Government of the Republic of Indonesia. It is very clear that these rebels aim at creating unrest among the population by means of looting, agitation and the like, in order that the people will loose their confidence in the Government. They have attempted to incite and influence the organs of Government by capitalizing upon the discontent that arises from and hardship of present-day living. The troops which have always remained in the interior and the troops which have been with drawn from the pockets, and in particular the Siliwangi troops, have been played off against one another. They have tried to sow dissension among our armed forces in order to paralyse them so that it will be easy for them to overthrow the Government. The former IV’th. Division in Solo has been infiltrated by elements bent on creating disturbance and led by Jadau and Soejoto, both of whom are exmembers of the Indone sian Naval Force, which has been dissolved, because it is of no use. As a consequence there occurred a clash between the armed forces in Solo. Actually this clash could have been easily suppressed and settled peacefully but the in surgents did not desire such an outcome; instead they continued with their incitements and
97
98 made a political issue out of this clash. I hereby pronounce that officers such as Jadau and Soejoto are discharged from the Army. Brothers! Now I must disclose a more serious incident to you: Yesterday morning the Communist Party of Musso staged a coup in Madiun and formed a Soviet Government there under the leadership of Musso. They consider this seizure of power by force as a preliminary step in the seizure of the entire Government of the Republic of Indonesia. From this fact it is obvious that the Solo and Madiun-incidents are not isolated events but are constituent parts of an over-all pattern of action designed to overthrow the Govern ment of the Republic of Indonesia. To achieve this end the rebels have used units of the 29th. Brigade, the former irregular force commanded by Lt. Col. Dahlan. By so doing Dahlan has betrayed the country and has violated the oath of the Army. Therefore I hereby dismiss Dahlan from the Army. Brothers, consider carefully the meaning of this: Musso’s Communist Party is attempt ing to seize our beloved Republic of Indonesia. My beloved people, in the name of the struggle for Independent Indonesia I call on you at this extremely critical moment when you and I are experiencing the greatest test to make a choice between following Musso and his Communist Party who will obstruct the attainment of an Independent Indonesia or following Sukarno-Hatta, who, with the Almighty’s help, will lead our Republic of Indonesia to become an Independent Indonesia which is not subjected to any other country whatsoever. I am convinced that the people of Indonesia who have been struggling so long to achieve their independence, will not hesitate in making their choice. And if you do not hesitate in standing behind us and behind the lawful Government, I request that likewise you will not hesitate in your actions. Support the Government, exert yourselves to the utmost in supporting the Government’s organs in combating the insurgents, and restore the lawful administration in the region concerned. Madiun must be returned to our hands as soon as possible. Herewith I also pronounce, that all vital undertakings, such as the postal-, telephoneand telegraphic service, the railway-, gas- and electrical service, and State factories pro ducing oil, sugar, textiles and other products are now under military control, and military law and regulations apply to everyone employed in these enterprises. Brothers! We all have known for some time that the F.D.R. has been conducting a systematic campaign of mental terrorization against the laborers, peasants and civil service by means of intimidations and threats. If you brothers, really intend to defend the cause of truth, do not be afraid of either bluffs, intimidations or threats, but exert yourselves actively side by side with the Government and its organs to free yourselves from fear and to attain that real democracy where there is no place for tyranny and threats. Honest laborers, honest peasants, honest youth and honest people, do not give any support to this group of rebels. Do not be attracted by the call of their music. Through the robberies and kidnappings and the coup in Madiun, has been disclosed the objective of the F.D.R.-P.K.L, an objective they have been long and deliberately planning for the overthrow of the Government.
99 Listen, how criminal their programme is: Article XI of their programme which dates from the end of last February reads: In addition to the campaign mentioned in Art. VI (i.e. the legal activi ties), illegal positive actions must soon be carried out: a. to create disorders everywhere, as long as the Masjumi Cabinet is in office, by mobilizing all criminal gangs to plunder and commit robbery intensively day and night. The police force is not strong enough yet to suppress all this. If this can be done accurately and properly, the whole people will live in constant fear and consequently the Government will loose the confidence of the people. b. strong measures msut be taken, such as kidnapping if necessary, against those persons (including those who have withdrawn from the F.D.R.), who are combating the plans of the F.D.R., the Partai Buruh Merdeka (Independent Labour Party), S.B.G. (Sugar W orker’s Union) and the like. This is only a part of the programme which they have planned since February of this year. Formerly, the F.D.R. leaders contended that this programme was a forgery made by their opponents. But the recent events have clearly shown, that this was indeed their pro gramme; every step taken, such as kidnappings and etc., tallies in every respect with that programme. Brothers, my compatriots! Awaken! Our Government will be overthrown by a group of rebels which have no patience enough to wait for the decision of the people through general elections; they plan to destroy our country! Let us shoulder to shoulder destroy these rebels. Let us restore law and order under the guidance of the Government. Come, do not hesitate, We shall win, if the Almighty wills it. Sekali Merdeka, Tetap Merdeka.
END
Publication of the Ministry of Information, Republic of Indonesia. From the collection of Professor Kahin.
A ppendix C
Musso R adio B roadcast (SEPTEMBER 19,1948)
[An hour and a half after Sukarno’s speech, at 11:30 p.m., Musso replied. Calling on the population to overthrow Sukarno and Hatta and seize the power of the state in its own hands, he stated:] On September 18,1948, the citizens of Madiun seized the authority of state in their own hands. With that the citizens of Madiun have done their duty in our national revolution, which as a matter of fact must be led by the people and not by any other class! Our revolution has continued for three years under the leadership of the national bour geois class, which has always been uncertain and vague in its stand in facing the Imperial ists in general and America in particular. This is one of the reasons why economic and political conditions within the Republic are continually getting worse. That is why the people in general and the workers in particular have not been able to find any difference between present conditions and those existing under Dutch and Japanese regimes. Actu ally those in the Government have used our revolution for enriching themselves. Dining the Japanese occupation these persons acted as Quislings, Romusha [forced-labour]dealers and Heiho [Work-Corps]-propagandists. More than two million women became widows, because their husbands were Romushas. And now, the same persons are going to sell Indonesia and her people once more, to the American Imperialists. Soekarno, using false accusations and proofs, accused the People’s Democratic Front (FDR) and Musso’s Communist Party (PKI) as obstructionists. Has Soekarno forgotten that in Solo [Surakarta] he made use of Trotskyite traitors to terrorize and kidnap all Communists? Has Soekarno forgotten that he promoted and sanctified the crimes of the Siliwangi Division and these terrorists? What is the objective of Soekarno, the exRomusha-dealer, in releasing Tan Malaka, a criminal who endeavored to overthrow his Presidency? It is clear that during the past three years Soekarno-Hatta, the ex-Romushadealers, the sworn Quislings, have executed a capitulation policy to the Dutch and the British, and at this very moment they are going to sell out Indonesia and her people to the American Imperialists. Can people of this kind claim that they have the just right to gov ern our Republic? The people of Indonesia are not blind! They understand that these Romusha-dealers are not fit to rule the country. The citizens of Madiun and some other places are breaking off connections with these imperialist satellites___ It was neither Soekarno nor Hatta who have opposed the Dutch, the British, and now the Americans; but rather the Indonesian people themselves. Therefore the happenings in Madiun and elsewhere are a signal to the whole people to wrest the powers of the state into their own hands. This is the only guarantee that the Republic will be truly sovereign,
101
102 and capable of facing all attacks from within and of liberating itself from these imperialist satellites. The people of Indonesia were asked by Soekarno to choose Soekarno or Musso! The people should answer back: “Soekarno-Hatta, the slaves of the Japanese and America! Traitors must die!” We are certain that the people will say: “Musso always serves the people of Indonesia!”
George McT. Kahin, Nationalism and Revolu tion in Indonesia (Ithaca, NY: Cornell Univer sity Press, 1952), pp. 293-94
S elected B ibliography
Abidin S. H., A. Z., and Lopa S. H., Baharuddin. Bahqja Komm unism e [The Danger of Communism]. Jakarta: Bulan Bintang, 1968. Afrin, G. “In Indonesia-Travel Notes.” New Times 45 (November 3,1948). Aidit, Dipa Nusantara. A id it Accuses the Madam A ffair. Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1955. _______ . The Birth and Growth o f die Communist Party o f Indonesia. Jakarta: Pem baruan, 1958. _______ . K onfiontasi Peristiwa M adiun 1948-~Perisüwa Sumatera 1956 [Confronting the Madiun Affair 1948-the Sumatra Affair 1956]. Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1964. _______ . Pilihan Tulisan [Selected Writings]. 3 vols. Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1959-65. _______ . A Short History o f the Communist Party. New Delhi: Peoples Publishing House, 1955. Alimin Prawirodirdjo. Riwajat Hidup A lim in [A Biography of the Life of Alimin]. Jakarta: Kesedjahteraan N.V., 1954. Anderson, Benedict R.O’G. Java in a Time o f Revolution. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1972. Anshary, M. Isa, Usman, Sjarif and Wibisono, Jusuf. Bahaja Merah di Indonesia [Red Threat in Indonesia]. Bandung: Front Anti-Komunis, 1955. Beloff, Max. Soviet Policy in the Far E ast 1944-1951. London: Oxford University Press, 1953. Benda, Harry J. and McVey, Ruth T., ed. The Comm unist Uprising? o f1926-7in Indone sia: Key D ocum ents. Translation Series. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Modern Indonesia Proj ect, 1960. Berezhkov, V. “Colonial War in Indonesia.” New Times 2 (January 4,1949): 7-9. Borkenau, Franz. European Communism. New York: Harper Brothers, 1953. Brackman, Arnold C. Indonesian Communism. New York: Praeger, 1963. de Bruyn, William F. The Rising Soviet Star Over Indonesia. The Hague: “De Hofstad,” 1947? Coast, John. Recm it to Revolution. London: Christophers, 1952.
103
104 Dahm, Bernhard. The History o f Indonesia in the Twentieth Century. New York: Praeger, 1971. Derita, S. P. UmaM inggu Sebeium M adiun A ffair [Five Weeks before the Madiun Affair]. Medan: Toko Buku Sarkawi, 1949. Dimyati, Muhammad. Sedjarah Perdjuangan Indonesia [The History of the Indonesian Struggle]. Jakarta: Widjaja, 1951. Djalan Barn untuk Republic Indonesia [A New Road for the Indonesian Republic]. Politbureau’s proposed resolution for discussion at the Fifth Congress of the PKI. Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1953. Effendi, Rustam. D em okrasidanD em okrasi [Democracy and Democracy]. Jakarta: Hang Tuah, 1955(?). Finch, Susan, and Lev, Daniel S. Republic o fIndonesia Cabinets, 1945-65. Interim Report Series. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Modern Indonesia Project, 1965. Fleming, D. F. The Cold War and its Origins 1917-1960. 2 vols. Garden City, NY: Dou bleday, 1961. Geertz, Clifford. The Religion o f Java. New York: The Free Press, 1960. Gerbrandy, P. S. Indonesia. New York: Hutchison, 1950. Grant, Bruce. Indonesia. Melbourne: Melbourne University Press, 1965. Hindley, Donald. The Communist Party o f Indonesia 1951-1963. Berkeley: University of California Press, 1964. Holt, Claire et al., ed. Culture and Politics in Indonesia. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1964. Horowitz, David. The Free World Colossus, A Critique o f Am erican Foreign Policy in the Cold War. London: MacGibbon and Kee, 1965. Indonesia, Departemen Pendidikan Dasar dan Kebudajaan, Biro Pemuda. Sedjarah Perdjuangan Pemuda Indonesia [The History of the Struggle of Indonesian Youth]. Jakarta: Balai Pustaka, 1965. Indonesia, Kementerian Luar Negeri. Fakta dan dokumen2 untuk M enjusun buku “Indo nesia M emasuki Gelanggan Intem asional,” Sub-periode: Peristiwa M adiun dan P olitik Bebas. Vol. 7 and Kabinet H atta Ke I dari Tanggal 29-1-48 Sam pai 19-12-48. Vol. 6 [Facts and Documents for use in the book “Indonesia Enters the International Forum,” Sub-period: The Madiun Affair and an Independent Foreign Policy and The First Hatta Cabinet from 29-1-48 to 19-12-48.] Jakarta: Kementerian Luar Negeri, Direk torat V, Seksi Penjelidikan dan Dokumentasi/Perpustakaan, June 1958. Jay, Robert R. Religion and Politics in Rural Central Java. New Haven: Yale University Press, 1963. Kahin, George McT. Nationalism and Revolution in Indonesia. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Uni versity Press, 1952.
105 _______ . “Some Aspects of Indonesian Politics and Nationalism.” Secretariat Paper No. 6 of the 11th Conference, Institute of Pacific Relations, Luknow, India, October 3-15, 1950. Kennedy, Malcolm. A H istory o f Communism in E astA sia. New York: Praeger, 1957. Kertapati, Sidik. SekitarProklam asi 17Augustus 1945 [Concerning the Proclamation of 17 August 1945]. Jakarta: Pembaruan, 1964. Koentjaraningrat, ed. Villages in Indonesia. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1957. Legge, J. D. Sukarno, A PoliticalBiography. New York: Praeger, 1972. Marbun, Mula. Gerakan Operasi M iliter I untukM enum pas Peristiwa M adiun [The Move ment for Military Operations I to Exterminate Madiun]. Jakarta: Pusat Sedjarah Angkatan Bersendjata, 1965. Marsudi, Djamal. PeristiwaM adium [The Madium Affair]. Jakarta: Merdeka Press, 1966. McVey, Ruth T. The Calcutta Conference and the Southeast A sian Uprisings. Interim Reports Series. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Modern Indonesia Project, 1958. _______ . The R ise o f Indonesian Communism. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1965. _______ . “The Southeast Asian Insurrectionary Movements” in Cyril E. Black and Tho mas P. Thornton, ed. Communism and Revolution, The Strategic Uses o f Political Vio lence. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press, 1964. ■ The Soviet View o f the Indonesian Revolution. Interim Reports Series. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Modern Indonesia Project, 1957. Mintz, Jeanne S. M ohammed, Marx and Marhaen, The Roots o f Indonesian Socialism . New York: Praeger, 1965. Mirajadi. “Tiga Tahun Provokasi Madiun” [Three Years after the Madiun Provocation]. BintangM erah, August/September 1951, pp. 39-52. Moersahid Wongsodirdjo. “17 Augustus dan Kementerian Luar Negeri” [17th of August and the Ministry of Foreign Affairs] in Darius Marpaung Bingkisan N asional Kenangan 10 Tahun Revolusi Indonesia [National Souvenirs, Remembrances of 10 years of the Indonesian Revolution]. Jakarta: P.T. Upeni, 1955(?). Mortimer, R. A. “The Ideology of the Communist Party of Indonesia under Guided Democracy 1959-65.” Ph.D. dissertation, Monash University, 1970. Nasution, Abdul Haris. Sedjarah Perdjuangan N asional dibidang Bersendjata [The His tory of the National Struggle in the Field of the Military]. Jakarta: Tjotas, 1966. _______ . Tentara N asional Indonesia [Indonesian National Armed Forces]. Vol. 2. Jakarta: Sending Masa, 1971. _______ . Tentara N asional Indonesia Vol. 3. Jakarta: Sending Masa, 1971. _______ . T]atatan2 SeJdtar P olitik M iliter Indonesia [Notes about Indonesian Military Policy]. Jakarta: Pembinbing, 1955. Notosoetardjo, H. A. Peristiwa M adiun Tragedi N asional [The Madiun Affair—a National Tragedy]. Jakarta: Api Islam, 1966.
106 Oudang, M. Perkerhbangan Kepoüsian di Indonesia [The Development of the Police in Indonesia]. Jakarta: Mahabharata, 1952. Pauker, Guy J. “Indonesia, the PKI’s Road to Power” in Robert A. Scalapino, ed. The Com m unist Revolution in A sia. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall, 1965. _______ . The Rise and Fall o f the Communist Party o f Indonesia. Santa Monica, CA: Rand Corporation, 1969. The Pentagon Papers, The Senator Gravel Edition. Vol. 1. Boston: Beacon Press, 1971. PKI History Institute. Forty Years o f the Communist Party o f Indonesia. US Joint Public Research Service translation, May 4,1961. Pinardi. Peristiwa Coup Berdarah P K I September 1948 d i M adam [The Affair of the Bloody PKI Coup of September 1948 in Madiun]. Jakarta: Inkopak-Hazera, 1967. Police Report. August 20,1948 (Yogyakarta). Official document from a private Indone sian collection. Pusat Sedjarah Militer Angkatan Darat. Penman TNI-Angjcatan Darat dalam Penmg Kemerdekaan (Revolusi P isik 1945-1949) [The Role of the Indonesian Armed Forces (Army) in the War of Independence (the Physical Revolution 1945-1959)]. Bandung: Pussemad, 1965. Rasid, Gadis. “Madiun.” Berita Yudha, October 2,1966. Ray, J. K. Transfer o f Power in Indonesia 1942-1949. Bombay: Manaktala, 1967. Rocamora, J. Eliseo. “The Partai Nasional Indonesia, 1948-1965.” Indonesia 10 (October 1970):143-81. Roeder, O. G. The Sm iling General: President Suharto o f Indonesia. Jakarta: Gunung Agung, 1970. Roth, Andrew. “American Flip Flop in Indonesia.” The Nation 167 (July 10,1948):39-41. _______ . “Jokja Journal.” The Nation 166 (June 2 6 ,1948):115-77. Rubinstein, Alvin Z. The Foreign Policy o f the Soviet Union. New York: Random House, 1960. Sedjarah Militer Kodam VI Siliwangi. Siliwangi dan Masa Kemasa [The Siliwangi from Era to Era]. Jakarta: Fakta Mahjuma, 1968. “Sedjarah TNI Komando Daerah VII Diponegoro” [The History of the Indonesian Armed Forces, Area VII Command, The Diponegoro]. Typescript in the Archives of the Army Military History Center (Pussemad), Bandung, 1963(?). Selosoemardjan. Social Changes in Jogjakarta. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1962. Seton-Watson, Hugh. From Lenin to Krushchev. New York: Praeger, 1960. Simatupang, Tahi Bonar. Laporan dan Banaran, Kisah Pengalaman Seorang Pradjurit Selam a Perang Kemerdekaan [Report from Banaran, The Story of a Soldier in the War for Independence]. Jakarta: Pembangunan, 1959. Sjahrir, Sutan. Indonesian Socialism . Rangoon: Asian Socialist Publishing House, 1956.
107 _______ . O ut o f Exile. New York: John Day, 1949. Smail, John R. W. Bandung in the Early Revolution, 1945-1946: A Study in the Social H is tory o f the Indonesian Revolution. Monograph Series. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Modern Indonesia Project, 1964. Soe Hok Gie. “Simpang Kiri dari Sebuah Djalan—Pemberontakan PKI di Madiun Sep tember 1948M[The PKI Rebellion in Madiun September 1948]. M A . thesis, University of Indonesia, Jakarta, 1969. Soekirno. Semarang. Semarang: Djawatan Penerangan Kota Besar Semarang, 1956(?). Sofian, Manai. “Surat dari Jokja.” Merdeka, February 14,1948, p. 4. Steklov, I. “Imperialist Aggression in Indonesia.” New Times 47 (November 16,1949):49. Sukarno. Kepada Bangsaku [To My People]. Jakarta: Panitia Pembina Djiwa Revolusi, 1962. Sutomo. Kenangan Bahagia [Happy Memories]. Yogyakarta: Balapan, 195?. _______ . Sesudah “M adiun” dan “Gestapu” lantas A pa? [After Madiun and Gestapu then what?]. Jakarta: Balapan, 1965. Sutter, John O. Indonesianisasi, Politics in a Changing Econom y 1940-1955. Ithaca, NY: Southeast Asia Program Data Paper No. 36,1959. Tamin, Djamaluddin. Sedjarah PK I [The History of the PKI]. Xerox copy in Cornell Uni versity Library, undated. Tan Malaka. Dari Pendjara Ke Pendjara [From Prison to Prison]. Vol. 3. Jakarta: Widjaja, n.d. _______ . Uraian M endadak (7 Nop. 1948). Jakarta: Komisariat Dewan Partai Murba, 1955. Tarly, S. T. Gelanggang Revolusi: 10 Tahun Proklamasi [The Forum of the Revolution: 10 years since the Proclamation]. Jakarta: UPMI, 1955. Taylor, Alastair M. Indonesian Independence and the United N ations. Ithaca, NY: Cornell University Press, 1960. Tedjasukmana, Iskandar. The Political Character o f the Indonesian Trade Union Move m ent. Monograph Series. Ithaca, NY: Cornell Modern Indonesia Project, 1958. Ulam, Adam B. Expansion and Coexistence, The History o f Soviet Foreign Policy 1917-67. New York: Praeger, 1968. _______ . The Rivals, Am erica and Russia since World War H. New York: Viking Press, 1971. _______ . Titoism and the Cominform. Cambridge, MA: HarvardUniversity Press, 1952. United States Department of State. Foreign Relations o f the UnitedStates 1947 VoL 6 The Far East. Washington: US Government Printing Office, 1972.
108 _______ . Foreign Relations o f the United States 1948 VoL 6 The Far E ast and Australia. Washington: US Government Printing Office, 1974. United States Foreign Broadcast Information Service (FBIS). Daily Reports, Foreign Radio Broadcasts, Far Eastern Section, Netherlands East Indies (1948). Vailland, Roger. Boroboudour, Voyage a Bali, Java et Autres Iles. Paris: Correa, 1951. Van Mook, H. J. The Stakes o f Democracy in SoutheastA sia. New York: Norton, 1950. Wolfe, Thomas W. Soviet Power and Europe 1945-1970. Baltimore: John Hopkins Press, 1970. Yamin, Muhamad. Sapta Dharma (Patriotisme Indonesia) [Sapta Dharma (Indonesian Patriotism)]. Medan: Toko Buku Islamijah, 1950. Zhadanov, A. Situasi P olitik Intem asional [The International Political Situation]. Yogyakarta: Mingguan Revolusioner, May 1948.
A nnotated B ibliography of the C ontemporary I ndonesian P ress
A badi (Jakarta) - Masyumi daily, not published in 1948. A neta News Bulletin (Jakarta) - Dutch daily news service in English and Indonesian in 1948. Only scattered issues available. Antara (Yogyakarta) - Indonesian government news service (not available for 1948 except as quoted by other sources). Bangun (Surabaya) - Bi-monthly, only scattered issues available. Berita Indonesia (Jakarta) - Indonesian nationalist daily edited by M. Sjaaf. Available for all of 1948. Generally more radical in outlook than Merdeka (see below) with some connections to the followers of Tan Malaka. BintangM erah (Jakarta) - PKI bi-monthly magazine. Not available in 1948. Djiwa Islam (Yogyakarta) - Weekly Masyumi paper. Only two issues available in 1948. G untur (Yogyakarta) - Daily Masyumi paper. Only a few articles available in Professor Kahin’s translation files. Indonesia (Bandung) - Started in May 1948. Name changed to Honan Indonesia, July 5, 1948. Daily available for all 1948. KengPo (Jakarta) - Chinese-run daily. Pro-Republic. Available for all of 1948. M adjalah Merdeka (Jakarta) - Weekly magazine of Merdeka run by Herawati Diah, the wife of M erdeka’s editor. Indonesian nationalist in orientation but more conservative than M erdeka. Available for most of 1948. M asalah Perburuhan (Yogyakarta) - Monthly publication of the Ministry of Labor and Social Affairs of the Republic of Indonesia. Only one issue available for 1948. M enant M erdeka (Kediri) - Bi-monthly, only a few issues available for 1948. Merah Putih (Yogyakarta) - Weekly PSI paper, available only after November 1948. M erdeka (Jakarta) - Indonesian nationalist daily edited by B. M. Diah. Slightly more con servative than Berita Indonesia. Available for all of 1948. M erdeka (New Delhi) - Indonesian Information Service pubication, only available for May 31,1948. Merdeka, The Voice o f Free Indonesia (New York) - Publication of the Republic of Indo nesia Office, New York. Only available after September 23,1948.
109
110 M imbar Indonesia (Jakarta) - Indonesian nationalist weekly magazine. Scattered issues available for 1948. Minggu Pag, (Yogyakarta) - Weekly of Kedaulatan Rakyat which started publication De cember 1948. M wba (Solo) - Daily (?) paper of Tan Malaka’s followers. Available only in Professor Kahin’s translation files. N asional (Yogyakarta) - Daily independent newspaper available only in Professor Kahin’s translation files. Pandji R a’ja t (Jakarta) - Dutch propaganda organ apparently run more or less bi-weekly. Reporting limited almost entirely to Netherlands East Indies government affairs. Available for most of 1948. Pedoman (Jakarta) - PSI daily paper not published in 1948. Pelita Rakyat (Surabaya) - Apparently Chinese-run daily. Only a few issues available for 1948. Persatoean (Bandung) - Daily available for most of 1948 but draws mainly from A neta for its sources. Pusara (Yogyakarta) - Monthly magazine of Taman Siswa schools. Only one issue avail able: October 1948. Revotusioner (Yogyakarta) - Pesindo weekly magazine only available in Professor Kahin’s translation files. Siasat (Jakarta) - PKI weekly magazine. Only scattered issues available for 1948. Sikap (Jakarta) - PSI weekly magazine which began August 17,1948. Only scattered issues available thereafter. Sikap K ita (Yogyakarta) - Weekly PSI theoretical magazine available for most of 1948. Sin M in (Semarang) - Chinese-run daily. Only scattered issues available for 1948. Sipatahoenan (Bandung) - Available for all of 1948 but written in Sundanese. Soeloeh Tentara (Yogyakarta) - Publication of Pepolit Pusat, the information and propa ganda section of the TNI. March 7, July 1948 only available. Star Weekly (Jakarta) - Weekly magazine of KengPo. Only scattered issues available for 1948. Suara Ibu Kota (Yogyakarta) - Official PKI daily. Only articles available for 1948. Trompet M asjarakat (Surabaya) - Chinese-run weekly. Scattered issues available for 1948. Voice o f Free Indonesia (Yogyakarta) - Daily publication of the Ministry of Information of the Republic of Indonesia. Available only for September 23-December 15,1948.
N ame I ndex
Abdulmadjid: p. 8 ,19n, 46n, 50,57,59 Abikusno: p. 49n Abu Hanifah: p. 10 Afrin (Tass correspondent): pp. 26-27n, 36 Aidit, D. N.: p. 57,59,60,74,80n, 82,90n Alimin: p. 6n, 8,27,51,52,57,59,60,74,80n Alip Hartojo: p. 67,68 Amir Sjarifuddin: p. 5-9,11-14,16-26,27n, 28n, 29n, 31,35n, 38n, 39,41,42,44,47n, 49,50, 52n, 55,57,58n, 59,61,65,67,69,74,78-80,89-91 Anderson, Benedict: p. 66n Anwar, Samsu: 27n Baay, Maj. Gen.: p. 62 Baharuddin: p. 13n, 45n Brackman, Arnold: p. 29n Chiang Kai-shek: p. 83 Cochran, Ambassador Merle: p. 82-84,85n, 86,90n Critchley, T. K.: p. 40,82 Dachlan, Col.: p. 73,77n Dahm, Bernhard: p. 64n Darsono: p. 51 Darusman, Maruto: p. 7 ,23n, 41,42,57,59,60,80n, 90 de Groot, Paul: p. 82 Derita: p. 55n Dimitrov line: p. 7-9, 52 Dimyati: p. 24n
111
112 Djatikusumo: p. 46 Djojomartono, Muljadi: p. 66n Djokosudjono: p. 52n Djokosujono, Maj. Gen.: p. 48n, 74,77n, 80n, 90n Djuanda: p. 21,49 Dubois, Coert: p. 37,38n, 40,84n Effendi, Rustam: p. 59n, 67 Fangiday, Francisca: p. 27n, 80n Flynn, Errol: p. 69 Foote, US Consul Walter A.: p. 12n Gable, Clark: p. 69 Gottwald, Klement: p. 29, 53n Graham, Dr. Frank: p. 17n, 18,21,26n Gromyko, Andrei: p. 27n Hadikusumo, Ki Bagus: p. 18n Hamengku Buwono DC, Sultan of Yogyakarta: p. 15,21,29n, 76 Harjono: p. 8 ,28n, 90n Hasjim, Wachid: p. 10 Hatta cabinet: p. 19,22-25,36, 38,46,49 Hatta government: p. 14,20, 24,27, 30,33,35-38, 41,45,47-49, 55,62, 66,67,72n, 75, 7779,83, 84, 87,88,90,91 Hatta, Mohd.: p. 2n, 3 ,13n, 14,15,18-22,28,29n, 30,31,38,39,42-44,48,58,63-66,68,75, 76,82-86,90 Herremans, Raymond: p. 82 Ho Chi Minh: p. 8, 9n, 52, 58 Hopkins, [Gerard] Harry: p. 82, 83 Ibnu Parna: p. 67 Idris, Kemal: p. 80n Iskandar, Col. Holan: p. 79n Iskandardinata, Oto: p. 68 Iskandardinata, Col. Sentot: p. 42,68 Isman: p. 12n, 13,15 Jadau, Lt. Col.: p. 71n, 77 Jasin, Mohammad: p. 78,79n
113 Jusuf: p. 52 Kahin, George: p. 6n, 24n, 35n, 44n, 48n, 60n, 61,68,89 Karno, S.: p. 79n Kartawiguna, Pandu: p. 49n Kasimo (Catholic Party): p. 20,61 Kasman Singodimedjo: p. 48 Kemal Idris, see Idris, Kemal Koesnan: p. 21 Krissubanu: p. 8 Leimena, Johannes: p. 21 Linggajati Agreements: p. 2,56,62 Livengood, Charles: p. 37,84 Lovett, Undersecretary Robert A.: p. 84,85n Lukman: p. 57,59,60,74,80n McDonald, Malcolm: p. 50 McVey, Ruth: p. 5 ,7n, 27,36,37,54,58,60n Malik, Adam: p. lln , 49n Mangku, D.: p. 90n Mao Tse-tung: p. 52,58,83 Maramis, A. A.: p. 20 Mardjono: p. 80n Marshall Plan: p. 36,83,86n Maskoer, Kiayi Haji: p. 21,71n Melik, Sajuti: p. 49n Mirajadi: p. 24n Muljadi Djojomartono, see Djojomartono, Muljadi Musso: p. 8n, 51-54,55n, 56-58,60-65,67,68,72,74-76,78,79,80n, 86-88,90,91 Mutalip, Abdul: p. 80n Muwardi, Dr.: p. lln , 12,23, 47n, 66,67,70, 82 Nasution, A. H.: p. 14,19, 45, 46,48,69,70n, 71,75,76, 77n, 79n Natsir, Mohammad: p. 10,21,58n, 82 Ngadiman: p. 57,60 Njono: p. 8
114 Njoto: p. 57,59,60 Oey Gee Hwat: p. 90n Ogburn, Charlton, Jr.: p. 17n, 82 Pamudji: p. 52n Parna, Ibnu, see Ibnu Parna Pauker, Guy: p. 76 Prawiranegara, Sjafruddin, see Sjafruddin Prawiranegara Pringgodigdo: p. 37n, 38n Rasid, Gadis: p. 72n Renville Agreements: p. 2 ,3 ,13n, 16-18,22,25,27,28 30,34n, 36,37,38n, 39,40,49,56,58, 62,64,82,84,90 Rijadi, Slamet: p. 71n, 77 Ritman, J. H.: p. 28n Roem, Mohd.: p. 37n, 82 Rondonuwu, Otto: p. 27n Ronomarsono, Katamhadi: p. 90n Roth, Andrew: p. 3n, 50,83n Rukman: p. 69n, 70n Ruskak: p. 57 Sadikin, Col. Ali: p. 70,71 Sajuti Melik, see Melik, Sajuti Sakirman, Gen.: p. 48n Salim, Haji Agus: p. 20,21, 29,34, 35,38 Samsu Anwar, see Anwar, Samsu Samsuddin: p. 18n Santoso: p. 85 Sardjono: p. 8 ,52,57,59,60,80n, 90n Sastroamidjojo, Ali: p. 20,75 Schorr, Daniel: p. 27 Sentot Iskandardinata, Col., see Iskandardinata, Col. Sentot Setiadjit: p. 7n, 8, 23n, 34,42,50,57,59,61,67,74 Sidharto: p. 74n Silin, M. A.: p. 33, 34
115 Simatupang, Gen. T. B.: p. 24,78n Singodimedjo, Kasman, see Kasman Singodimedjo Siregar, Luat: p. 22n Sjafruddin Prawiranegara: p. 10,18,20,22,41,42 Sjahrir, Sutan: p. 5-9,11,12,14,18,19n, 24-26,29,34,35n, 40,43n, 47n Soe Hok Gie: p. 59 Sofian, Manai: p. lOn, 18n, 23,24n Spoor, Lt. General Simon: p. 85 Stalin, Joseph: p. 64 Stikker, Dirk U., Dutch Foreign Minister: p. 2n, 84,86 Suadi, Col.: p. 47,48,67-71,77 Subadio: p. 25n Subandrio: p. 89n Subroto, Gatot: p. 14,46,71-73,75,77,78,90n Sudewo, Erie: p. 79n Sudirman, Gen.: p. 12-14,21,40,42,45-48,61n, 64,67,68,70,71,75,76,79n Sudiro: p. 66n Sudisman: p. 57 Sugeng, Bambang: p. 46 Suharto, Col. (later President): p. 75 Sujoto, Lt. Col.: p. 71n, 77 “Sukamto,” see Soekanto Soekanto, Raden Said: p. 82 Sukarno, President: p. 2n, 5,7,11,13-15,19,21n, 24n, 31,34,35,43,45,49n, 51,53,66,68, 71,75,76,77n, 79,80,82-84,86,89,90 Sukarno (low level PKI leader): p. 90n Sukiman, Dr,: p. 10,18n, 20,23,35n, 42,44,76n, 82 Sultan of Yogyakarta, see Hamengku Buwono IX Sumadi, Achmad: p. 52n Sumarsono (Pesindo): p. 48,61,72-74,80n, 88,90 Sungkono: p. 46-48,73n, 76-78,79n Supardi: p. 74 Supeno (PSI): p. 21,26,27n, 61
116 Supeno, Bambang: p. 46 Surachman, Col.: p. 78n Suripno: p. 6n, 9n, 33-36,38-40,44n, 51-53,57,60n, 61,63,72n, 74,75n, 76,80,89,90n Susalit, Maj. Gen.: p. 45n, 46 Sutarto, Gen.: p. 14,46-48 Sutomo (Bung Tomo): p. 12n, 13,30,45,69,78n, 79n Sutrisno: p. 57 Suwardi, Maj. Gen.: p. 45n Tamzil: p. 34,35n Tan Ling Djie: p. 8,50,57,59,60,74,80n Tan Malaka: p. 11,13,15,17n, 23,42,47n, 49,51,52n, 59,66 Tirtoprodjo, Susanto: p. 20 Tito: p. 36,54,57 Tjokroaminoto: p. 51,53 Tjokronegoro, A.: p. 19n, 57 Trimurti: p. 49n Truman, President Harry: p. 82 Vailland, Roger: p. 81,82 van Mook, Lt. Gov. Gen. H. J.: p. 34n, 35n van Vredenburch, Henri: p. 39 Wiguna, Pandu Karta: p. lln Wikana: p. 8 ,9 ,1 5 ,5 0 ,5 7 ,6 1 ,7 4 ,75n, 80n Wiranatakusumah, Achmad: p. 68,69,70n Wiranatakusumah, R. A. A.: p. 68 Wirjono: p. 25 Wongsodirdjo, Moersahid: p. 37n Zhdanov, thesis: p. 7,9,26,27,51,54-56,87 Zhukov: p. 9